xref: /openbmc/linux/include/net/cfg80211.h (revision bcda5fd3)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 #ifndef __NET_CFG80211_H
3 #define __NET_CFG80211_H
4 /*
5  * 802.11 device and configuration interface
6  *
7  * Copyright 2006-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright 2015-2017	Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018-2021 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #include <linux/ethtool.h>
14 #include <uapi/linux/rfkill.h>
15 #include <linux/netdevice.h>
16 #include <linux/debugfs.h>
17 #include <linux/list.h>
18 #include <linux/bug.h>
19 #include <linux/netlink.h>
20 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
21 #include <linux/nl80211.h>
22 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
23 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
24 #include <linux/net.h>
25 #include <linux/rfkill.h>
26 #include <net/regulatory.h>
27 
28 /**
29  * DOC: Introduction
30  *
31  * cfg80211 is the configuration API for 802.11 devices in Linux. It bridges
32  * userspace and drivers, and offers some utility functionality associated
33  * with 802.11. cfg80211 must, directly or indirectly via mac80211, be used
34  * by all modern wireless drivers in Linux, so that they offer a consistent
35  * API through nl80211. For backward compatibility, cfg80211 also offers
36  * wireless extensions to userspace, but hides them from drivers completely.
37  *
38  * Additionally, cfg80211 contains code to help enforce regulatory spectrum
39  * use restrictions.
40  */
41 
42 
43 /**
44  * DOC: Device registration
45  *
46  * In order for a driver to use cfg80211, it must register the hardware device
47  * with cfg80211. This happens through a number of hardware capability structs
48  * described below.
49  *
50  * The fundamental structure for each device is the 'wiphy', of which each
51  * instance describes a physical wireless device connected to the system. Each
52  * such wiphy can have zero, one, or many virtual interfaces associated with
53  * it, which need to be identified as such by pointing the network interface's
54  * @ieee80211_ptr pointer to a &struct wireless_dev which further describes
55  * the wireless part of the interface, normally this struct is embedded in the
56  * network interface's private data area. Drivers can optionally allow creating
57  * or destroying virtual interfaces on the fly, but without at least one or the
58  * ability to create some the wireless device isn't useful.
59  *
60  * Each wiphy structure contains device capability information, and also has
61  * a pointer to the various operations the driver offers. The definitions and
62  * structures here describe these capabilities in detail.
63  */
64 
65 struct wiphy;
66 
67 /*
68  * wireless hardware capability structures
69  */
70 
71 /**
72  * enum ieee80211_channel_flags - channel flags
73  *
74  * Channel flags set by the regulatory control code.
75  *
76  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED: This channel is disabled.
77  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR: do not initiate radiation, this includes
78  *	sending probe requests or beaconing.
79  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR: Radar detection is required on this channel.
80  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS: extension channel above this channel
81  *	is not permitted.
82  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS: extension channel below this channel
83  *	is not permitted.
84  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM: OFDM is not allowed on this channel.
85  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ: If the driver supports 80 MHz on the band,
86  *	this flag indicates that an 80 MHz channel cannot use this
87  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
88  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
89  *	restrictions.
90  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ: If the driver supports 160 MHz on the band,
91  *	this flag indicates that an 160 MHz channel cannot use this
92  *	channel as the control or any of the secondary channels.
93  *	This may be due to the driver or due to regulatory bandwidth
94  *	restrictions.
95  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_INDOOR_ONLY
96  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT: see %NL80211_FREQUENCY_ATTR_IR_CONCURRENT
97  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ: 20 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
98  *	on this channel.
99  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ: 10 MHz bandwidth is not permitted
100  *	on this channel.
101  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE: HE operation is not permitted on this channel.
102  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ: 1 MHz bandwidth is permitted
103  *	on this channel.
104  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ: 2 MHz bandwidth is permitted
105  *	on this channel.
106  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ: 4 MHz bandwidth is permitted
107  *	on this channel.
108  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ: 8 MHz bandwidth is permitted
109  *	on this channel.
110  * @IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ: 16 MHz bandwidth is permitted
111  *	on this channel.
112  *
113  */
114 enum ieee80211_channel_flags {
115 	IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED		= 1<<0,
116 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_IR		= 1<<1,
117 	/* hole at 1<<2 */
118 	IEEE80211_CHAN_RADAR		= 1<<3,
119 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS	= 1<<4,
120 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS	= 1<<5,
121 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_OFDM		= 1<<6,
122 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_80MHZ		= 1<<7,
123 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_160MHZ	= 1<<8,
124 	IEEE80211_CHAN_INDOOR_ONLY	= 1<<9,
125 	IEEE80211_CHAN_IR_CONCURRENT	= 1<<10,
126 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_20MHZ		= 1<<11,
127 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_10MHZ		= 1<<12,
128 	IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HE		= 1<<13,
129 	IEEE80211_CHAN_1MHZ		= 1<<14,
130 	IEEE80211_CHAN_2MHZ		= 1<<15,
131 	IEEE80211_CHAN_4MHZ		= 1<<16,
132 	IEEE80211_CHAN_8MHZ		= 1<<17,
133 	IEEE80211_CHAN_16MHZ		= 1<<18,
134 };
135 
136 #define IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40 \
137 	(IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40PLUS | IEEE80211_CHAN_NO_HT40MINUS)
138 
139 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_CAC_TIME_MS		60000
140 #define IEEE80211_DFS_MIN_NOP_TIME_MS		(30 * 60 * 1000)
141 
142 /**
143  * struct ieee80211_channel - channel definition
144  *
145  * This structure describes a single channel for use
146  * with cfg80211.
147  *
148  * @center_freq: center frequency in MHz
149  * @freq_offset: offset from @center_freq, in KHz
150  * @hw_value: hardware-specific value for the channel
151  * @flags: channel flags from &enum ieee80211_channel_flags.
152  * @orig_flags: channel flags at registration time, used by regulatory
153  *	code to support devices with additional restrictions
154  * @band: band this channel belongs to.
155  * @max_antenna_gain: maximum antenna gain in dBi
156  * @max_power: maximum transmission power (in dBm)
157  * @max_reg_power: maximum regulatory transmission power (in dBm)
158  * @beacon_found: helper to regulatory code to indicate when a beacon
159  *	has been found on this channel. Use regulatory_hint_found_beacon()
160  *	to enable this, this is useful only on 5 GHz band.
161  * @orig_mag: internal use
162  * @orig_mpwr: internal use
163  * @dfs_state: current state of this channel. Only relevant if radar is required
164  *	on this channel.
165  * @dfs_state_entered: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
166  * @dfs_cac_ms: DFS CAC time in milliseconds, this is valid for DFS channels.
167  */
168 struct ieee80211_channel {
169 	enum nl80211_band band;
170 	u32 center_freq;
171 	u16 freq_offset;
172 	u16 hw_value;
173 	u32 flags;
174 	int max_antenna_gain;
175 	int max_power;
176 	int max_reg_power;
177 	bool beacon_found;
178 	u32 orig_flags;
179 	int orig_mag, orig_mpwr;
180 	enum nl80211_dfs_state dfs_state;
181 	unsigned long dfs_state_entered;
182 	unsigned int dfs_cac_ms;
183 };
184 
185 /**
186  * enum ieee80211_rate_flags - rate flags
187  *
188  * Hardware/specification flags for rates. These are structured
189  * in a way that allows using the same bitrate structure for
190  * different bands/PHY modes.
191  *
192  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Hardware can send with short
193  *	preamble on this bitrate; only relevant in 2.4GHz band and
194  *	with CCK rates.
195  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
196  *	when used with 802.11a (on the 5 GHz band); filled by the
197  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
198  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
199  *	when used with 802.11b (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
200  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
201  * @IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G: This bitrate is a mandatory rate
202  *	when used with 802.11g (on the 2.4 GHz band); filled by the
203  *	core code when registering the wiphy.
204  * @IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G: This is an ERP rate in 802.11g mode.
205  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ: Rate can be used in 5 MHz mode
206  * @IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ: Rate can be used in 10 MHz mode
207  */
208 enum ieee80211_rate_flags {
209 	IEEE80211_RATE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<0,
210 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_A	= 1<<1,
211 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_B	= 1<<2,
212 	IEEE80211_RATE_MANDATORY_G	= 1<<3,
213 	IEEE80211_RATE_ERP_G		= 1<<4,
214 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ	= 1<<5,
215 	IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ	= 1<<6,
216 };
217 
218 /**
219  * enum ieee80211_bss_type - BSS type filter
220  *
221  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS: Infrastructure BSS
222  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS: Personal BSS
223  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS: Independent BSS
224  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS: Mesh BSS
225  * @IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any BSS type
226  */
227 enum ieee80211_bss_type {
228 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ESS,
229 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_PBSS,
230 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
231 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_MBSS,
232 	IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_ANY
233 };
234 
235 /**
236  * enum ieee80211_privacy - BSS privacy filter
237  *
238  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON: privacy bit set
239  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF: privacy bit clear
240  * @IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY: Wildcard value for matching any privacy setting
241  */
242 enum ieee80211_privacy {
243 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON,
244 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF,
245 	IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY
246 };
247 
248 #define IEEE80211_PRIVACY(x)	\
249 	((x) ? IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ON : IEEE80211_PRIVACY_OFF)
250 
251 /**
252  * struct ieee80211_rate - bitrate definition
253  *
254  * This structure describes a bitrate that an 802.11 PHY can
255  * operate with. The two values @hw_value and @hw_value_short
256  * are only for driver use when pointers to this structure are
257  * passed around.
258  *
259  * @flags: rate-specific flags
260  * @bitrate: bitrate in units of 100 Kbps
261  * @hw_value: driver/hardware value for this rate
262  * @hw_value_short: driver/hardware value for this rate when
263  *	short preamble is used
264  */
265 struct ieee80211_rate {
266 	u32 flags;
267 	u16 bitrate;
268 	u16 hw_value, hw_value_short;
269 };
270 
271 /**
272  * struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd - AP settings for spatial reuse
273  *
274  * @enable: is the feature enabled.
275  * @sr_ctrl: The SR Control field of SRP element.
276  * @non_srg_max_offset: non-SRG maximum tx power offset
277  * @min_offset: minimal tx power offset an associated station shall use
278  * @max_offset: maximum tx power offset an associated station shall use
279  * @bss_color_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the BSS color values used by
280  *	members of the SRG
281  * @partial_bssid_bitmap: bitmap that indicates the partial BSSID values
282  *	used by members of the SRG
283  */
284 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd {
285 	bool enable;
286 	u8 sr_ctrl;
287 	u8 non_srg_max_offset;
288 	u8 min_offset;
289 	u8 max_offset;
290 	u8 bss_color_bitmap[8];
291 	u8 partial_bssid_bitmap[8];
292 };
293 
294 /**
295  * struct cfg80211_he_bss_color - AP settings for BSS coloring
296  *
297  * @color: the current color.
298  * @enabled: HE BSS color is used
299  * @partial: define the AID equation.
300  */
301 struct cfg80211_he_bss_color {
302 	u8 color;
303 	bool enabled;
304 	bool partial;
305 };
306 
307 /**
308  * struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap - STA's HT capabilities
309  *
310  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
311  * to describe 802.11n HT capabilities for an STA.
312  *
313  * @ht_supported: is HT supported by the STA
314  * @cap: HT capabilities map as described in 802.11n spec
315  * @ampdu_factor: Maximum A-MPDU length factor
316  * @ampdu_density: Minimum A-MPDU spacing
317  * @mcs: Supported MCS rates
318  */
319 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap {
320 	u16 cap; /* use IEEE80211_HT_CAP_ */
321 	bool ht_supported;
322 	u8 ampdu_factor;
323 	u8 ampdu_density;
324 	struct ieee80211_mcs_info mcs;
325 };
326 
327 /**
328  * struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap - STA's VHT capabilities
329  *
330  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
331  * to describe 802.11ac VHT capabilities for an STA.
332  *
333  * @vht_supported: is VHT supported by the STA
334  * @cap: VHT capabilities map as described in 802.11ac spec
335  * @vht_mcs: Supported VHT MCS rates
336  */
337 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap {
338 	bool vht_supported;
339 	u32 cap; /* use IEEE80211_VHT_CAP_ */
340 	struct ieee80211_vht_mcs_info vht_mcs;
341 };
342 
343 #define IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN		25
344 
345 /**
346  * struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap - STA's HE capabilities
347  *
348  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
349  * to describe 802.11ax HE capabilities for a STA.
350  *
351  * @has_he: true iff HE data is valid.
352  * @he_cap_elem: Fixed portion of the HE capabilities element.
353  * @he_mcs_nss_supp: The supported NSS/MCS combinations.
354  * @ppe_thres: Holds the PPE Thresholds data.
355  */
356 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap {
357 	bool has_he;
358 	struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem he_cap_elem;
359 	struct ieee80211_he_mcs_nss_supp he_mcs_nss_supp;
360 	u8 ppe_thres[IEEE80211_HE_PPE_THRES_MAX_LEN];
361 };
362 
363 /**
364  * struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data - sband data per interface type
365  *
366  * This structure encapsulates sband data that is relevant for the
367  * interface types defined in @types_mask.  Each type in the
368  * @types_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_data.
369  *
370  * @types_mask: interface types mask
371  * @he_cap: holds the HE capabilities
372  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz capabilities, must be filled in for a
373  *	6 GHz band channel (and 0 may be valid value).
374  * @vendor_elems: vendor element(s) to advertise
375  * @vendor_elems.data: vendor element(s) data
376  * @vendor_elems.len: vendor element(s) length
377  */
378 struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data {
379 	u16 types_mask;
380 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
381 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
382 	struct {
383 		const u8 *data;
384 		unsigned int len;
385 	} vendor_elems;
386 };
387 
388 /**
389  * enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config - allowed channel bandwidth configurations
390  *
391  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4: 2.16GHz
392  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5: 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz
393  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 6.48GHz
394  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 8.64GHz
395  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8: 2.16GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
396  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz and 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
397  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz and 2.16GHz+2.16GHz
398  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz and
399  *	2.16GHz+2.16GHz
400  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12: 2.16GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
401  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
402  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and
403  *	4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
404  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 2.16GHz + 2.16GHz
405  *	and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
406  * @IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15: 2.16GHz, 4.32GHz, 6.48GHz, 8.64GHz,
407  *	2.16GHz + 2.16GHz and 4.32GHz + 4.32GHz
408  */
409 enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config {
410 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_4	= 4,
411 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_5	= 5,
412 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_6	= 6,
413 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_7	= 7,
414 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_8	= 8,
415 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_9	= 9,
416 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_10	= 10,
417 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_11	= 11,
418 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_12	= 12,
419 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_13	= 13,
420 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_14	= 14,
421 	IEEE80211_EDMG_BW_CONFIG_15	= 15,
422 };
423 
424 /**
425  * struct ieee80211_edmg - EDMG configuration
426  *
427  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
428  * to describe 802.11ay EDMG configuration
429  *
430  * @channels: bitmap that indicates the 2.16 GHz channel(s)
431  *	that are allowed to be used for transmissions.
432  *	Bit 0 indicates channel 1, bit 1 indicates channel 2, etc.
433  *	Set to 0 indicate EDMG not supported.
434  * @bw_config: Channel BW Configuration subfield encodes
435  *	the allowed channel bandwidth configurations
436  */
437 struct ieee80211_edmg {
438 	u8 channels;
439 	enum ieee80211_edmg_bw_config bw_config;
440 };
441 
442 /**
443  * struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap - STA's S1G capabilities
444  *
445  * This structure describes most essential parameters needed
446  * to describe 802.11ah S1G capabilities for a STA.
447  *
448  * @s1g_supported: is STA an S1G STA
449  * @cap: S1G capabilities information
450  * @nss_mcs: Supported NSS MCS set
451  */
452 struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap {
453 	bool s1g;
454 	u8 cap[10]; /* use S1G_CAPAB_ */
455 	u8 nss_mcs[5];
456 };
457 
458 /**
459  * struct ieee80211_supported_band - frequency band definition
460  *
461  * This structure describes a frequency band a wiphy
462  * is able to operate in.
463  *
464  * @channels: Array of channels the hardware can operate with
465  *	in this band.
466  * @band: the band this structure represents
467  * @n_channels: Number of channels in @channels
468  * @bitrates: Array of bitrates the hardware can operate with
469  *	in this band. Must be sorted to give a valid "supported
470  *	rates" IE, i.e. CCK rates first, then OFDM.
471  * @n_bitrates: Number of bitrates in @bitrates
472  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities in this band
473  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities in this band
474  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band
475  * @edmg_cap: EDMG capabilities in this band
476  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities in this band (S1B band only, of course)
477  * @n_iftype_data: number of iftype data entries
478  * @iftype_data: interface type data entries.  Note that the bits in
479  *	@types_mask inside this structure cannot overlap (i.e. only
480  *	one occurrence of each type is allowed across all instances of
481  *	iftype_data).
482  */
483 struct ieee80211_supported_band {
484 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels;
485 	struct ieee80211_rate *bitrates;
486 	enum nl80211_band band;
487 	int n_channels;
488 	int n_bitrates;
489 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
490 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
491 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
492 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg_cap;
493 	u16 n_iftype_data;
494 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *iftype_data;
495 };
496 
497 /**
498  * ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data - return sband data for a given iftype
499  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
500  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
501  *
502  * Return: pointer to struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data, or NULL is none found
503  */
504 static inline const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *
505 ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
506 				u8 iftype)
507 {
508 	int i;
509 
510 	if (WARN_ON(iftype >= NL80211_IFTYPE_MAX))
511 		return NULL;
512 
513 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_iftype_data; i++)  {
514 		const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
515 			&sband->iftype_data[i];
516 
517 		if (data->types_mask & BIT(iftype))
518 			return data;
519 	}
520 
521 	return NULL;
522 }
523 
524 /**
525  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap - return HE capabilities for an sband's iftype
526  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
527  * @iftype: enum nl80211_iftype
528  *
529  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or NULL is none found
530  */
531 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
532 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
533 			    u8 iftype)
534 {
535 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
536 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
537 
538 	if (data && data->he_cap.has_he)
539 		return &data->he_cap;
540 
541 	return NULL;
542 }
543 
544 /**
545  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
546  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
547  * @iftype: the iftype to search for
548  *
549  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
550  */
551 static inline __le16
552 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
553 			   enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
554 {
555 	const struct ieee80211_sband_iftype_data *data =
556 		ieee80211_get_sband_iftype_data(sband, iftype);
557 
558 	if (WARN_ON(!data || !data->he_cap.has_he))
559 		return 0;
560 
561 	return data->he_6ghz_capa.capa;
562 }
563 
564 /**
565  * wiphy_read_of_freq_limits - read frequency limits from device tree
566  *
567  * @wiphy: the wireless device to get extra limits for
568  *
569  * Some devices may have extra limitations specified in DT. This may be useful
570  * for chipsets that normally support more bands but are limited due to board
571  * design (e.g. by antennas or external power amplifier).
572  *
573  * This function reads info from DT and uses it to *modify* channels (disable
574  * unavailable ones). It's usually a *bad* idea to use it in drivers with
575  * shared channel data as DT limitations are device specific. You should make
576  * sure to call it only if channels in wiphy are copied and can be modified
577  * without affecting other devices.
578  *
579  * As this function access device node it has to be called after set_wiphy_dev.
580  * It also modifies channels so they have to be set first.
581  * If using this helper, call it before wiphy_register().
582  */
583 #ifdef CONFIG_OF
584 void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy);
585 #else /* CONFIG_OF */
586 static inline void wiphy_read_of_freq_limits(struct wiphy *wiphy)
587 {
588 }
589 #endif /* !CONFIG_OF */
590 
591 
592 /*
593  * Wireless hardware/device configuration structures and methods
594  */
595 
596 /**
597  * DOC: Actions and configuration
598  *
599  * Each wireless device and each virtual interface offer a set of configuration
600  * operations and other actions that are invoked by userspace. Each of these
601  * actions is described in the operations structure, and the parameters these
602  * operations use are described separately.
603  *
604  * Additionally, some operations are asynchronous and expect to get status
605  * information via some functions that drivers need to call.
606  *
607  * Scanning and BSS list handling with its associated functionality is described
608  * in a separate chapter.
609  */
610 
611 #define VHT_MUMIMO_GROUPS_DATA_LEN (WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN +\
612 				    WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN)
613 
614 /**
615  * struct vif_params - describes virtual interface parameters
616  * @flags: monitor interface flags, unchanged if 0, otherwise
617  *	%MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED will be set
618  * @use_4addr: use 4-address frames
619  * @macaddr: address to use for this virtual interface.
620  *	If this parameter is set to zero address the driver may
621  *	determine the address as needed.
622  *	This feature is only fully supported by drivers that enable the
623  *	%NL80211_FEATURE_MAC_ON_CREATE flag.  Others may support creating
624  **	only p2p devices with specified MAC.
625  * @vht_mumimo_groups: MU-MIMO groupID, used for monitoring MU-MIMO packets
626  *	belonging to that MU-MIMO groupID; %NULL if not changed
627  * @vht_mumimo_follow_addr: MU-MIMO follow address, used for monitoring
628  *	MU-MIMO packets going to the specified station; %NULL if not changed
629  */
630 struct vif_params {
631 	u32 flags;
632 	int use_4addr;
633 	u8 macaddr[ETH_ALEN];
634 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_groups;
635 	const u8 *vht_mumimo_follow_addr;
636 };
637 
638 /**
639  * struct key_params - key information
640  *
641  * Information about a key
642  *
643  * @key: key material
644  * @key_len: length of key material
645  * @cipher: cipher suite selector
646  * @seq: sequence counter (IV/PN) for TKIP and CCMP keys, only used
647  *	with the get_key() callback, must be in little endian,
648  *	length given by @seq_len.
649  * @seq_len: length of @seq.
650  * @vlan_id: vlan_id for VLAN group key (if nonzero)
651  * @mode: key install mode (RX_TX, NO_TX or SET_TX)
652  */
653 struct key_params {
654 	const u8 *key;
655 	const u8 *seq;
656 	int key_len;
657 	int seq_len;
658 	u16 vlan_id;
659 	u32 cipher;
660 	enum nl80211_key_mode mode;
661 };
662 
663 /**
664  * struct cfg80211_chan_def - channel definition
665  * @chan: the (control) channel
666  * @width: channel width
667  * @center_freq1: center frequency of first segment
668  * @center_freq2: center frequency of second segment
669  *	(only with 80+80 MHz)
670  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels configuration.
671  *	If edmg is requested (i.e. the .channels member is non-zero),
672  *	chan will define the primary channel and all other
673  *	parameters are ignored.
674  * @freq1_offset: offset from @center_freq1, in KHz
675  */
676 struct cfg80211_chan_def {
677 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
678 	enum nl80211_chan_width width;
679 	u32 center_freq1;
680 	u32 center_freq2;
681 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
682 	u16 freq1_offset;
683 };
684 
685 /*
686  * cfg80211_bitrate_mask - masks for bitrate control
687  */
688 struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask {
689 	struct {
690 		u32 legacy;
691 		u8 ht_mcs[IEEE80211_HT_MCS_MASK_LEN];
692 		u16 vht_mcs[NL80211_VHT_NSS_MAX];
693 		u16 he_mcs[NL80211_HE_NSS_MAX];
694 		enum nl80211_txrate_gi gi;
695 		enum nl80211_he_gi he_gi;
696 		enum nl80211_he_ltf he_ltf;
697 	} control[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
698 };
699 
700 
701 /**
702  * struct cfg80211_tid_cfg - TID specific configuration
703  * @config_override: Flag to notify driver to reset TID configuration
704  *	of the peer.
705  * @tids: bitmap of TIDs to modify
706  * @mask: bitmap of attributes indicating which parameter changed,
707  *	similar to &nl80211_tid_config_supp.
708  * @noack: noack configuration value for the TID
709  * @retry_long: retry count value
710  * @retry_short: retry count value
711  * @ampdu: Enable/Disable MPDU aggregation
712  * @rtscts: Enable/Disable RTS/CTS
713  * @amsdu: Enable/Disable MSDU aggregation
714  * @txrate_type: Tx bitrate mask type
715  * @txrate_mask: Tx bitrate to be applied for the TID
716  */
717 struct cfg80211_tid_cfg {
718 	bool config_override;
719 	u8 tids;
720 	u64 mask;
721 	enum nl80211_tid_config noack;
722 	u8 retry_long, retry_short;
723 	enum nl80211_tid_config ampdu;
724 	enum nl80211_tid_config rtscts;
725 	enum nl80211_tid_config amsdu;
726 	enum nl80211_tx_rate_setting txrate_type;
727 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask txrate_mask;
728 };
729 
730 /**
731  * struct cfg80211_tid_config - TID configuration
732  * @peer: Station's MAC address
733  * @n_tid_conf: Number of TID specific configurations to be applied
734  * @tid_conf: Configuration change info
735  */
736 struct cfg80211_tid_config {
737 	const u8 *peer;
738 	u32 n_tid_conf;
739 	struct cfg80211_tid_cfg tid_conf[];
740 };
741 
742 /**
743  * cfg80211_get_chandef_type - return old channel type from chandef
744  * @chandef: the channel definition
745  *
746  * Return: The old channel type (NOHT, HT20, HT40+/-) from a given
747  * chandef, which must have a bandwidth allowing this conversion.
748  */
749 static inline enum nl80211_channel_type
750 cfg80211_get_chandef_type(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
751 {
752 	switch (chandef->width) {
753 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
754 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
755 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
756 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT20;
757 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
758 		if (chandef->center_freq1 > chandef->chan->center_freq)
759 			return NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS;
760 		return NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS;
761 	default:
762 		WARN_ON(1);
763 		return NL80211_CHAN_NO_HT;
764 	}
765 }
766 
767 /**
768  * cfg80211_chandef_create - create channel definition using channel type
769  * @chandef: the channel definition struct to fill
770  * @channel: the control channel
771  * @chantype: the channel type
772  *
773  * Given a channel type, create a channel definition.
774  */
775 void cfg80211_chandef_create(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
776 			     struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
777 			     enum nl80211_channel_type chantype);
778 
779 /**
780  * cfg80211_chandef_identical - check if two channel definitions are identical
781  * @chandef1: first channel definition
782  * @chandef2: second channel definition
783  *
784  * Return: %true if the channels defined by the channel definitions are
785  * identical, %false otherwise.
786  */
787 static inline bool
788 cfg80211_chandef_identical(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
789 			   const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2)
790 {
791 	return (chandef1->chan == chandef2->chan &&
792 		chandef1->width == chandef2->width &&
793 		chandef1->center_freq1 == chandef2->center_freq1 &&
794 		chandef1->freq1_offset == chandef2->freq1_offset &&
795 		chandef1->center_freq2 == chandef2->center_freq2);
796 }
797 
798 /**
799  * cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg - check if chandef represents an EDMG channel
800  *
801  * @chandef: the channel definition
802  *
803  * Return: %true if EDMG defined, %false otherwise.
804  */
805 static inline bool
806 cfg80211_chandef_is_edmg(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
807 {
808 	return chandef->edmg.channels || chandef->edmg.bw_config;
809 }
810 
811 /**
812  * cfg80211_chandef_compatible - check if two channel definitions are compatible
813  * @chandef1: first channel definition
814  * @chandef2: second channel definition
815  *
816  * Return: %NULL if the given channel definitions are incompatible,
817  * chandef1 or chandef2 otherwise.
818  */
819 const struct cfg80211_chan_def *
820 cfg80211_chandef_compatible(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef1,
821 			    const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef2);
822 
823 /**
824  * cfg80211_chandef_valid - check if a channel definition is valid
825  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
826  * Return: %true if the channel definition is valid. %false otherwise.
827  */
828 bool cfg80211_chandef_valid(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
829 
830 /**
831  * cfg80211_chandef_usable - check if secondary channels can be used
832  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
833  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
834  * @prohibited_flags: the regulatory channel flags that must not be set
835  * Return: %true if secondary channels are usable. %false otherwise.
836  */
837 bool cfg80211_chandef_usable(struct wiphy *wiphy,
838 			     const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
839 			     u32 prohibited_flags);
840 
841 /**
842  * cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required - checks if radar detection is required
843  * @wiphy: the wiphy to validate against
844  * @chandef: the channel definition to check
845  * @iftype: the interface type as specified in &enum nl80211_iftype
846  * Returns:
847  *	1 if radar detection is required, 0 if it is not, < 0 on error
848  */
849 int cfg80211_chandef_dfs_required(struct wiphy *wiphy,
850 				  const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
851 				  enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
852 
853 /**
854  * ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags - returns rate flags for a channel
855  *
856  * In some channel types, not all rates may be used - for example CCK
857  * rates may not be used in 5/10 MHz channels.
858  *
859  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
860  *
861  * Returns: rate flags which apply for this channel
862  */
863 static inline enum ieee80211_rate_flags
864 ieee80211_chandef_rate_flags(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
865 {
866 	switch (chandef->width) {
867 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
868 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_5MHZ;
869 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
870 		return IEEE80211_RATE_SUPPORTS_10MHZ;
871 	default:
872 		break;
873 	}
874 	return 0;
875 }
876 
877 /**
878  * ieee80211_chandef_max_power - maximum transmission power for the chandef
879  *
880  * In some regulations, the transmit power may depend on the configured channel
881  * bandwidth which may be defined as dBm/MHz. This function returns the actual
882  * max_power for non-standard (20 MHz) channels.
883  *
884  * @chandef: channel definition for the channel
885  *
886  * Returns: maximum allowed transmission power in dBm for the chandef
887  */
888 static inline int
889 ieee80211_chandef_max_power(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
890 {
891 	switch (chandef->width) {
892 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
893 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 6,
894 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
895 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
896 		return min(chandef->chan->max_reg_power - 3,
897 			   chandef->chan->max_power);
898 	default:
899 		break;
900 	}
901 	return chandef->chan->max_power;
902 }
903 
904 /**
905  * cfg80211_any_usable_channels - check for usable channels
906  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check for
907  * @band_mask: which bands to check on
908  * @prohibited_flags: which channels to not consider usable,
909  *	%IEEE80211_CHAN_DISABLED is always taken into account
910  */
911 bool cfg80211_any_usable_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy,
912 				  unsigned long band_mask,
913 				  u32 prohibited_flags);
914 
915 /**
916  * enum survey_info_flags - survey information flags
917  *
918  * @SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM: noise (in dBm) was filled in
919  * @SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE: channel is currently being used
920  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME: active time (in ms) was filled in
921  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY: busy time was filled in
922  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY: extension channel busy time was filled in
923  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX: receive time was filled in
924  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX: transmit time was filled in
925  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN: scan time was filled in
926  * @SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX: local BSS receive time was filled in
927  *
928  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct survey_info
929  * it has filled in during the get_survey().
930  */
931 enum survey_info_flags {
932 	SURVEY_INFO_NOISE_DBM		= BIT(0),
933 	SURVEY_INFO_IN_USE		= BIT(1),
934 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME		= BIT(2),
935 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BUSY		= BIT(3),
936 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_EXT_BUSY	= BIT(4),
937 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_RX		= BIT(5),
938 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_TX		= BIT(6),
939 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_SCAN		= BIT(7),
940 	SURVEY_INFO_TIME_BSS_RX		= BIT(8),
941 };
942 
943 /**
944  * struct survey_info - channel survey response
945  *
946  * @channel: the channel this survey record reports, may be %NULL for a single
947  *	record to report global statistics
948  * @filled: bitflag of flags from &enum survey_info_flags
949  * @noise: channel noise in dBm. This and all following fields are
950  *	optional
951  * @time: amount of time in ms the radio was turn on (on the channel)
952  * @time_busy: amount of time the primary channel was sensed busy
953  * @time_ext_busy: amount of time the extension channel was sensed busy
954  * @time_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data
955  * @time_tx: amount of time the radio spent transmitting data
956  * @time_scan: amount of time the radio spent for scanning
957  * @time_bss_rx: amount of time the radio spent receiving data on a local BSS
958  *
959  * Used by dump_survey() to report back per-channel survey information.
960  *
961  * This structure can later be expanded with things like
962  * channel duty cycle etc.
963  */
964 struct survey_info {
965 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
966 	u64 time;
967 	u64 time_busy;
968 	u64 time_ext_busy;
969 	u64 time_rx;
970 	u64 time_tx;
971 	u64 time_scan;
972 	u64 time_bss_rx;
973 	u32 filled;
974 	s8 noise;
975 };
976 
977 #define CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS	4
978 
979 /**
980  * struct cfg80211_crypto_settings - Crypto settings
981  * @wpa_versions: indicates which, if any, WPA versions are enabled
982  *	(from enum nl80211_wpa_versions)
983  * @cipher_group: group key cipher suite (or 0 if unset)
984  * @n_ciphers_pairwise: number of AP supported unicast ciphers
985  * @ciphers_pairwise: unicast key cipher suites
986  * @n_akm_suites: number of AKM suites
987  * @akm_suites: AKM suites
988  * @control_port: Whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
989  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
990  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
991  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
992  * @control_port_ethertype: the control port protocol that should be
993  *	allowed through even on unauthorized ports
994  * @control_port_no_encrypt: TRUE to prevent encryption of control port
995  *	protocol frames.
996  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
997  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
998  * @control_port_no_preauth: disables pre-auth rx over the nl80211 control
999  *	port for mac80211
1000  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
1001  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
1002  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
1003  * @psk: PSK (for devices supporting 4-way-handshake offload)
1004  * @sae_pwd: password for SAE authentication (for devices supporting SAE
1005  *	offload)
1006  * @sae_pwd_len: length of SAE password (for devices supporting SAE offload)
1007  * @sae_pwe: The mechanisms allowed for SAE PWE derivation:
1008  *
1009  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_UNSPECIFIED
1010  *	  Not-specified, used to indicate userspace did not specify any
1011  *	  preference. The driver should follow its internal policy in
1012  *	  such a scenario.
1013  *
1014  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HUNT_AND_PECK
1015  *	  Allow hunting-and-pecking loop only
1016  *
1017  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_HASH_TO_ELEMENT
1018  *	  Allow hash-to-element only
1019  *
1020  *	NL80211_SAE_PWE_BOTH
1021  *	  Allow either hunting-and-pecking loop or hash-to-element
1022  */
1023 struct cfg80211_crypto_settings {
1024 	u32 wpa_versions;
1025 	u32 cipher_group;
1026 	int n_ciphers_pairwise;
1027 	u32 ciphers_pairwise[NL80211_MAX_NR_CIPHER_SUITES];
1028 	int n_akm_suites;
1029 	u32 akm_suites[NL80211_MAX_NR_AKM_SUITES];
1030 	bool control_port;
1031 	__be16 control_port_ethertype;
1032 	bool control_port_no_encrypt;
1033 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
1034 	bool control_port_no_preauth;
1035 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
1036 	int wep_tx_key;
1037 	const u8 *psk;
1038 	const u8 *sae_pwd;
1039 	u8 sae_pwd_len;
1040 	enum nl80211_sae_pwe_mechanism sae_pwe;
1041 };
1042 
1043 /**
1044  * struct cfg80211_beacon_data - beacon data
1045  * @head: head portion of beacon (before TIM IE)
1046  *	or %NULL if not changed
1047  * @tail: tail portion of beacon (after TIM IE)
1048  *	or %NULL if not changed
1049  * @head_len: length of @head
1050  * @tail_len: length of @tail
1051  * @beacon_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Beacon frames or %NULL
1052  * @beacon_ies_len: length of beacon_ies in octets
1053  * @proberesp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into Probe Response
1054  *	frames or %NULL
1055  * @proberesp_ies_len: length of proberesp_ies in octets
1056  * @assocresp_ies: extra information element(s) to add into (Re)Association
1057  *	Response frames or %NULL
1058  * @assocresp_ies_len: length of assocresp_ies in octets
1059  * @probe_resp_len: length of probe response template (@probe_resp)
1060  * @probe_resp: probe response template (AP mode only)
1061  * @ftm_responder: enable FTM responder functionality; -1 for no change
1062  *	(which also implies no change in LCI/civic location data)
1063  * @lci: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement Token
1064  *	(measurement type 8)
1065  * @civicloc: Measurement Report element content, starting with Measurement
1066  *	Token (measurement type 11)
1067  * @lci_len: LCI data length
1068  * @civicloc_len: Civic location data length
1069  */
1070 struct cfg80211_beacon_data {
1071 	const u8 *head, *tail;
1072 	const u8 *beacon_ies;
1073 	const u8 *proberesp_ies;
1074 	const u8 *assocresp_ies;
1075 	const u8 *probe_resp;
1076 	const u8 *lci;
1077 	const u8 *civicloc;
1078 	s8 ftm_responder;
1079 
1080 	size_t head_len, tail_len;
1081 	size_t beacon_ies_len;
1082 	size_t proberesp_ies_len;
1083 	size_t assocresp_ies_len;
1084 	size_t probe_resp_len;
1085 	size_t lci_len;
1086 	size_t civicloc_len;
1087 };
1088 
1089 struct mac_address {
1090 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1091 };
1092 
1093 /**
1094  * struct cfg80211_acl_data - Access control list data
1095  *
1096  * @acl_policy: ACL policy to be applied on the station's
1097  *	entry specified by mac_addr
1098  * @n_acl_entries: Number of MAC address entries passed
1099  * @mac_addrs: List of MAC addresses of stations to be used for ACL
1100  */
1101 struct cfg80211_acl_data {
1102 	enum nl80211_acl_policy acl_policy;
1103 	int n_acl_entries;
1104 
1105 	/* Keep it last */
1106 	struct mac_address mac_addrs[];
1107 };
1108 
1109 /**
1110  * struct cfg80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
1111  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
1112  *
1113  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1114  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
1115  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1116  * @tmpl: Template data for FILS discovery frame including the action
1117  *	frame headers.
1118  */
1119 struct cfg80211_fils_discovery {
1120 	u32 min_interval;
1121 	u32 max_interval;
1122 	size_t tmpl_len;
1123 	const u8 *tmpl;
1124 };
1125 
1126 /**
1127  * struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp - Unsolicited broadcast probe
1128  *	response parameters in 6GHz.
1129  *
1130  * @interval: Packet interval in TUs. Maximum allowed is 20 TU, as mentioned
1131  *	in IEEE P802.11ax/D6.0 26.17.2.3.2 - AP behavior for fast passive
1132  *	scanning
1133  * @tmpl_len: Template length
1134  * @tmpl: Template data for probe response
1135  */
1136 struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp {
1137 	u32 interval;
1138 	size_t tmpl_len;
1139 	const u8 *tmpl;
1140 };
1141 
1142 /**
1143  * enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags - AP settings flags
1144  *
1145  * Used by cfg80211_ap_settings
1146  *
1147  * @AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: AP supports external authentication
1148  */
1149 enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags {
1150 	AP_SETTINGS_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT = BIT(0),
1151 };
1152 
1153 /**
1154  * struct cfg80211_ap_settings - AP configuration
1155  *
1156  * Used to configure an AP interface.
1157  *
1158  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
1159  * @beacon: beacon data
1160  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1161  * @dtim_period: DTIM period
1162  * @ssid: SSID to be used in the BSS (note: may be %NULL if not provided from
1163  *	user space)
1164  * @ssid_len: length of @ssid
1165  * @hidden_ssid: whether to hide the SSID in Beacon/Probe Response frames
1166  * @crypto: crypto settings
1167  * @privacy: the BSS uses privacy
1168  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
1169  * @smps_mode: SMPS mode
1170  * @inactivity_timeout: time in seconds to determine station's inactivity.
1171  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window
1172  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS
1173  * @acl: ACL configuration used by the drivers which has support for
1174  *	MAC address based access control
1175  * @pbss: If set, start as a PCP instead of AP. Relevant for DMG
1176  *	networks.
1177  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
1178  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities (or %NULL if HT isn't enabled)
1179  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities (or %NULL if VHT isn't enabled)
1180  * @he_cap: HE capabilities (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1181  * @ht_required: stations must support HT
1182  * @vht_required: stations must support VHT
1183  * @twt_responder: Enable Target Wait Time
1184  * @he_required: stations must support HE
1185  * @sae_h2e_required: stations must support direct H2E technique in SAE
1186  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum cfg80211_ap_settings_flags
1187  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection settings
1188  * @he_bss_color: BSS Color settings
1189  * @he_oper: HE operation IE (or %NULL if HE isn't enabled)
1190  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery transmission parameters
1191  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp: Unsolicited broadcast probe response parameters
1192  */
1193 struct cfg80211_ap_settings {
1194 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1195 
1196 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon;
1197 
1198 	int beacon_interval, dtim_period;
1199 	const u8 *ssid;
1200 	size_t ssid_len;
1201 	enum nl80211_hidden_ssid hidden_ssid;
1202 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
1203 	bool privacy;
1204 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
1205 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1206 	int inactivity_timeout;
1207 	u8 p2p_ctwindow;
1208 	bool p2p_opp_ps;
1209 	const struct cfg80211_acl_data *acl;
1210 	bool pbss;
1211 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
1212 
1213 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_cap;
1214 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_cap;
1215 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_cap;
1216 	const struct ieee80211_he_operation *he_oper;
1217 	bool ht_required, vht_required, he_required, sae_h2e_required;
1218 	bool twt_responder;
1219 	u32 flags;
1220 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
1221 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
1222 	struct cfg80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
1223 	struct cfg80211_unsol_bcast_probe_resp unsol_bcast_probe_resp;
1224 };
1225 
1226 /**
1227  * struct cfg80211_csa_settings - channel switch settings
1228  *
1229  * Used for channel switch
1230  *
1231  * @chandef: defines the channel to use after the switch
1232  * @beacon_csa: beacon data while performing the switch
1233  * @counter_offsets_beacon: offsets of the counters within the beacon (tail)
1234  * @counter_offsets_presp: offsets of the counters within the probe response
1235  * @n_counter_offsets_beacon: number of csa counters the beacon (tail)
1236  * @n_counter_offsets_presp: number of csa counters in the probe response
1237  * @beacon_after: beacon data to be used on the new channel
1238  * @radar_required: whether radar detection is required on the new channel
1239  * @block_tx: whether transmissions should be blocked while changing
1240  * @count: number of beacons until switch
1241  */
1242 struct cfg80211_csa_settings {
1243 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1244 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_csa;
1245 	const u16 *counter_offsets_beacon;
1246 	const u16 *counter_offsets_presp;
1247 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_beacon;
1248 	unsigned int n_counter_offsets_presp;
1249 	struct cfg80211_beacon_data beacon_after;
1250 	bool radar_required;
1251 	bool block_tx;
1252 	u8 count;
1253 };
1254 
1255 /**
1256  * struct iface_combination_params - input parameters for interface combinations
1257  *
1258  * Used to pass interface combination parameters
1259  *
1260  * @num_different_channels: the number of different channels we want
1261  *	to use for verification
1262  * @radar_detect: a bitmap where each bit corresponds to a channel
1263  *	width where radar detection is needed, as in the definition of
1264  *	&struct ieee80211_iface_combination.@radar_detect_widths
1265  * @iftype_num: array with the number of interfaces of each interface
1266  *	type.  The index is the interface type as specified in &enum
1267  *	nl80211_iftype.
1268  * @new_beacon_int: set this to the beacon interval of a new interface
1269  *	that's not operating yet, if such is to be checked as part of
1270  *	the verification
1271  */
1272 struct iface_combination_params {
1273 	int num_different_channels;
1274 	u8 radar_detect;
1275 	int iftype_num[NUM_NL80211_IFTYPES];
1276 	u32 new_beacon_int;
1277 };
1278 
1279 /**
1280  * enum station_parameters_apply_mask - station parameter values to apply
1281  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD: apply new uAPSD parameters (uapsd_queues, max_sp)
1282  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY: apply new capability
1283  * @STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE: apply new plink state
1284  *
1285  * Not all station parameters have in-band "no change" signalling,
1286  * for those that don't these flags will are used.
1287  */
1288 enum station_parameters_apply_mask {
1289 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_UAPSD = BIT(0),
1290 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_CAPABILITY = BIT(1),
1291 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_PLINK_STATE = BIT(2),
1292 	STATION_PARAM_APPLY_STA_TXPOWER = BIT(3),
1293 };
1294 
1295 /**
1296  * struct sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1297  *
1298  * Used to configure txpower for station.
1299  *
1300  * @power: tx power (in dBm) to be used for sending data traffic. If tx power
1301  *	is not provided, the default per-interface tx power setting will be
1302  *	overriding. Driver should be picking up the lowest tx power, either tx
1303  *	power per-interface or per-station.
1304  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1305  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1306  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1307  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1308  *	per peer TPC.
1309  */
1310 struct sta_txpwr {
1311 	s16 power;
1312 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1313 };
1314 
1315 /**
1316  * struct station_parameters - station parameters
1317  *
1318  * Used to change and create a new station.
1319  *
1320  * @vlan: vlan interface station should belong to
1321  * @supported_rates: supported rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1322  *	(or NULL for no change)
1323  * @supported_rates_len: number of supported rates
1324  * @sta_flags_mask: station flags that changed
1325  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1326  * @sta_flags_set: station flags values
1327  *	(bitmask of BIT(%NL80211_STA_FLAG_...))
1328  * @listen_interval: listen interval or -1 for no change
1329  * @aid: AID or zero for no change
1330  * @vlan_id: VLAN ID for station (if nonzero)
1331  * @peer_aid: mesh peer AID or zero for no change
1332  * @plink_action: plink action to take
1333  * @plink_state: set the peer link state for a station
1334  * @ht_capa: HT capabilities of station
1335  * @vht_capa: VHT capabilities of station
1336  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. same format
1337  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
1338  * @max_sp: max Service Period. same format as the MAX_SP in the
1339  *	QoS info field (but already shifted down)
1340  * @sta_modify_mask: bitmap indicating which parameters changed
1341  *	(for those that don't have a natural "no change" value),
1342  *	see &enum station_parameters_apply_mask
1343  * @local_pm: local link-specific mesh power save mode (no change when set
1344  *	to unknown)
1345  * @capability: station capability
1346  * @ext_capab: extended capabilities of the station
1347  * @ext_capab_len: number of extended capabilities
1348  * @supported_channels: supported channels in IEEE 802.11 format
1349  * @supported_channels_len: number of supported channels
1350  * @supported_oper_classes: supported oper classes in IEEE 802.11 format
1351  * @supported_oper_classes_len: number of supported operating classes
1352  * @opmode_notif: operating mode field from Operating Mode Notification
1353  * @opmode_notif_used: information if operating mode field is used
1354  * @support_p2p_ps: information if station supports P2P PS mechanism
1355  * @he_capa: HE capabilities of station
1356  * @he_capa_len: the length of the HE capabilities
1357  * @airtime_weight: airtime scheduler weight for this station
1358  * @txpwr: transmit power for an associated station
1359  * @he_6ghz_capa: HE 6 GHz Band capabilities of station
1360  */
1361 struct station_parameters {
1362 	const u8 *supported_rates;
1363 	struct net_device *vlan;
1364 	u32 sta_flags_mask, sta_flags_set;
1365 	u32 sta_modify_mask;
1366 	int listen_interval;
1367 	u16 aid;
1368 	u16 vlan_id;
1369 	u16 peer_aid;
1370 	u8 supported_rates_len;
1371 	u8 plink_action;
1372 	u8 plink_state;
1373 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa;
1374 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa;
1375 	u8 uapsd_queues;
1376 	u8 max_sp;
1377 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1378 	u16 capability;
1379 	const u8 *ext_capab;
1380 	u8 ext_capab_len;
1381 	const u8 *supported_channels;
1382 	u8 supported_channels_len;
1383 	const u8 *supported_oper_classes;
1384 	u8 supported_oper_classes_len;
1385 	u8 opmode_notif;
1386 	bool opmode_notif_used;
1387 	int support_p2p_ps;
1388 	const struct ieee80211_he_cap_elem *he_capa;
1389 	u8 he_capa_len;
1390 	u16 airtime_weight;
1391 	struct sta_txpwr txpwr;
1392 	const struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa *he_6ghz_capa;
1393 };
1394 
1395 /**
1396  * struct station_del_parameters - station deletion parameters
1397  *
1398  * Used to delete a station entry (or all stations).
1399  *
1400  * @mac: MAC address of the station to remove or NULL to remove all stations
1401  * @subtype: Management frame subtype to use for indicating removal
1402  *	(10 = Disassociation, 12 = Deauthentication)
1403  * @reason_code: Reason code for the Disassociation/Deauthentication frame
1404  */
1405 struct station_del_parameters {
1406 	const u8 *mac;
1407 	u8 subtype;
1408 	u16 reason_code;
1409 };
1410 
1411 /**
1412  * enum cfg80211_station_type - the type of station being modified
1413  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT: client of an AP interface
1414  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC: client of an AP interface that is still
1415  *	unassociated (update properties for this type of client is permitted)
1416  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT: client of an AP interface that has
1417  *	the AP MLME in the device
1418  * @CFG80211_STA_AP_STA: AP station on managed interface
1419  * @CFG80211_STA_IBSS: IBSS station
1420  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP: TDLS peer on managed interface (dummy entry
1421  *	while TDLS setup is in progress, it moves out of this state when
1422  *	being marked authorized; use this only if TDLS with external setup is
1423  *	supported/used)
1424  * @CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE: TDLS peer on managed interface (active
1425  *	entry that is operating, has been marked authorized by userspace)
1426  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL: peer on mesh interface (kernel managed)
1427  * @CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER: peer on mesh interface (user managed)
1428  */
1429 enum cfg80211_station_type {
1430 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT,
1431 	CFG80211_STA_AP_CLIENT_UNASSOC,
1432 	CFG80211_STA_AP_MLME_CLIENT,
1433 	CFG80211_STA_AP_STA,
1434 	CFG80211_STA_IBSS,
1435 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_SETUP,
1436 	CFG80211_STA_TDLS_PEER_ACTIVE,
1437 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_KERNEL,
1438 	CFG80211_STA_MESH_PEER_USER,
1439 };
1440 
1441 /**
1442  * cfg80211_check_station_change - validate parameter changes
1443  * @wiphy: the wiphy this operates on
1444  * @params: the new parameters for a station
1445  * @statype: the type of station being modified
1446  *
1447  * Utility function for the @change_station driver method. Call this function
1448  * with the appropriate station type looking up the station (and checking that
1449  * it exists). It will verify whether the station change is acceptable, and if
1450  * not will return an error code. Note that it may modify the parameters for
1451  * backward compatibility reasons, so don't use them before calling this.
1452  */
1453 int cfg80211_check_station_change(struct wiphy *wiphy,
1454 				  struct station_parameters *params,
1455 				  enum cfg80211_station_type statype);
1456 
1457 /**
1458  * enum rate_info_flags - bitrate info flags
1459  *
1460  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1461  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1462  *
1463  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS: mcs field filled with HT MCS
1464  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS: mcs field filled with VHT MCS
1465  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI: 400ns guard interval
1466  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG: 60GHz MCS
1467  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS: HE MCS information
1468  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG: 60GHz MCS in EDMG mode
1469  * @RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG: 60GHz extended SC MCS
1470  */
1471 enum rate_info_flags {
1472 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_MCS			= BIT(0),
1473 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_VHT_MCS			= BIT(1),
1474 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1475 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_DMG			= BIT(3),
1476 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_HE_MCS			= BIT(4),
1477 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EDMG			= BIT(5),
1478 	RATE_INFO_FLAGS_EXTENDED_SC_DMG		= BIT(6),
1479 };
1480 
1481 /**
1482  * enum rate_info_bw - rate bandwidth information
1483  *
1484  * Used by the driver to indicate the rate bandwidth.
1485  *
1486  * @RATE_INFO_BW_5: 5 MHz bandwidth
1487  * @RATE_INFO_BW_10: 10 MHz bandwidth
1488  * @RATE_INFO_BW_20: 20 MHz bandwidth
1489  * @RATE_INFO_BW_40: 40 MHz bandwidth
1490  * @RATE_INFO_BW_80: 80 MHz bandwidth
1491  * @RATE_INFO_BW_160: 160 MHz bandwidth
1492  * @RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU: bandwidth determined by HE RU allocation
1493  */
1494 enum rate_info_bw {
1495 	RATE_INFO_BW_20 = 0,
1496 	RATE_INFO_BW_5,
1497 	RATE_INFO_BW_10,
1498 	RATE_INFO_BW_40,
1499 	RATE_INFO_BW_80,
1500 	RATE_INFO_BW_160,
1501 	RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU,
1502 };
1503 
1504 /**
1505  * struct rate_info - bitrate information
1506  *
1507  * Information about a receiving or transmitting bitrate
1508  *
1509  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum rate_info_flags
1510  * @mcs: mcs index if struct describes an HT/VHT/HE rate
1511  * @legacy: bitrate in 100kbit/s for 802.11abg
1512  * @nss: number of streams (VHT & HE only)
1513  * @bw: bandwidth (from &enum rate_info_bw)
1514  * @he_gi: HE guard interval (from &enum nl80211_he_gi)
1515  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1516  * @he_ru_alloc: HE RU allocation (from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc,
1517  *	only valid if bw is %RATE_INFO_BW_HE_RU)
1518  * @n_bonded_ch: In case of EDMG the number of bonded channels (1-4)
1519  */
1520 struct rate_info {
1521 	u8 flags;
1522 	u8 mcs;
1523 	u16 legacy;
1524 	u8 nss;
1525 	u8 bw;
1526 	u8 he_gi;
1527 	u8 he_dcm;
1528 	u8 he_ru_alloc;
1529 	u8 n_bonded_ch;
1530 };
1531 
1532 /**
1533  * enum bss_param_flags - bitrate info flags
1534  *
1535  * Used by the driver to indicate the specific rate transmission
1536  * type for 802.11n transmissions.
1537  *
1538  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT: whether CTS protection is enabled
1539  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE: whether short preamble is enabled
1540  * @BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME: whether short slot time is enabled
1541  */
1542 enum bss_param_flags {
1543 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_CTS_PROT	= 1<<0,
1544 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= 1<<1,
1545 	BSS_PARAM_FLAGS_SHORT_SLOT_TIME	= 1<<2,
1546 };
1547 
1548 /**
1549  * struct sta_bss_parameters - BSS parameters for the attached station
1550  *
1551  * Information about the currently associated BSS
1552  *
1553  * @flags: bitflag of flags from &enum bss_param_flags
1554  * @dtim_period: DTIM period for the BSS
1555  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval
1556  */
1557 struct sta_bss_parameters {
1558 	u8 flags;
1559 	u8 dtim_period;
1560 	u16 beacon_interval;
1561 };
1562 
1563 /**
1564  * struct cfg80211_txq_stats - TXQ statistics for this TID
1565  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_txq_stats to
1566  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1567  * @backlog_bytes: total number of bytes currently backlogged
1568  * @backlog_packets: total number of packets currently backlogged
1569  * @flows: number of new flows seen
1570  * @drops: total number of packets dropped
1571  * @ecn_marks: total number of packets marked with ECN CE
1572  * @overlimit: number of drops due to queue space overflow
1573  * @overmemory: number of drops due to memory limit overflow
1574  * @collisions: number of hash collisions
1575  * @tx_bytes: total number of bytes dequeued
1576  * @tx_packets: total number of packets dequeued
1577  * @max_flows: maximum number of flows supported
1578  */
1579 struct cfg80211_txq_stats {
1580 	u32 filled;
1581 	u32 backlog_bytes;
1582 	u32 backlog_packets;
1583 	u32 flows;
1584 	u32 drops;
1585 	u32 ecn_marks;
1586 	u32 overlimit;
1587 	u32 overmemory;
1588 	u32 collisions;
1589 	u32 tx_bytes;
1590 	u32 tx_packets;
1591 	u32 max_flows;
1592 };
1593 
1594 /**
1595  * struct cfg80211_tid_stats - per-TID statistics
1596  * @filled: bitmap of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_tid_stats to
1597  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct are filled
1598  * @rx_msdu: number of received MSDUs
1599  * @tx_msdu: number of (attempted) transmitted MSDUs
1600  * @tx_msdu_retries: number of retries (not counting the first) for
1601  *	transmitted MSDUs
1602  * @tx_msdu_failed: number of failed transmitted MSDUs
1603  * @txq_stats: TXQ statistics
1604  */
1605 struct cfg80211_tid_stats {
1606 	u32 filled;
1607 	u64 rx_msdu;
1608 	u64 tx_msdu;
1609 	u64 tx_msdu_retries;
1610 	u64 tx_msdu_failed;
1611 	struct cfg80211_txq_stats txq_stats;
1612 };
1613 
1614 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS	4
1615 
1616 /**
1617  * struct station_info - station information
1618  *
1619  * Station information filled by driver for get_station() and dump_station.
1620  *
1621  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_sta_info to
1622  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
1623  * @connected_time: time(in secs) since a station is last connected
1624  * @inactive_time: time since last station activity (tx/rx) in milliseconds
1625  * @assoc_at: bootime (ns) of the last association
1626  * @rx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) received from this station
1627  * @tx_bytes: bytes (size of MPDUs) transmitted to this station
1628  * @llid: mesh local link id
1629  * @plid: mesh peer link id
1630  * @plink_state: mesh peer link state
1631  * @signal: The signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1632  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1633  * @signal_avg: Average signal strength, type depends on the wiphy's signal_type.
1634  *	For CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM, value is expressed in _dBm_.
1635  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal, @chain_signal_avg
1636  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received packet in dBm
1637  * @chain_signal_avg: per-chain signal strength average in dBm
1638  * @txrate: current unicast bitrate from this station
1639  * @rxrate: current unicast bitrate to this station
1640  * @rx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) received from this station
1641  * @tx_packets: packets (MSDUs & MMPDUs) transmitted to this station
1642  * @tx_retries: cumulative retry counts (MPDUs)
1643  * @tx_failed: number of failed transmissions (MPDUs) (retries exceeded, no ACK)
1644  * @rx_dropped_misc:  Dropped for un-specified reason.
1645  * @bss_param: current BSS parameters
1646  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1647  *	This number should increase every time the list of stations
1648  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1649  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1650  * @assoc_req_ies: IEs from (Re)Association Request.
1651  *	This is used only when in AP mode with drivers that do not use
1652  *	user space MLME/SME implementation. The information is provided for
1653  *	the cfg80211_new_sta() calls to notify user space of the IEs.
1654  * @assoc_req_ies_len: Length of assoc_req_ies buffer in octets.
1655  * @sta_flags: station flags mask & values
1656  * @beacon_loss_count: Number of times beacon loss event has triggered.
1657  * @t_offset: Time offset of the station relative to this host.
1658  * @local_pm: local mesh STA power save mode
1659  * @peer_pm: peer mesh STA power save mode
1660  * @nonpeer_pm: non-peer mesh STA power save mode
1661  * @expected_throughput: expected throughput in kbps (including 802.11 headers)
1662  *	towards this station.
1663  * @rx_beacon: number of beacons received from this peer
1664  * @rx_beacon_signal_avg: signal strength average (in dBm) for beacons received
1665  *	from this peer
1666  * @connected_to_gate: true if mesh STA has a path to mesh gate
1667  * @rx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames from a peer
1668  * @tx_duration: aggregate PPDU duration(usecs) for all the frames to a peer
1669  * @airtime_weight: current airtime scheduling weight
1670  * @pertid: per-TID statistics, see &struct cfg80211_tid_stats, using the last
1671  *	(IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) index for MSDUs not encapsulated in QoS-MPDUs.
1672  *	Note that this doesn't use the @filled bit, but is used if non-NULL.
1673  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the last ACK frame.
1674  * @avg_ack_signal: average rssi value of ack packet for the no of msdu's has
1675  *	been sent.
1676  * @rx_mpdu_count: number of MPDUs received from this station
1677  * @fcs_err_count: number of packets (MPDUs) received from this station with
1678  *	an FCS error. This counter should be incremented only when TA of the
1679  *	received packet with an FCS error matches the peer MAC address.
1680  * @airtime_link_metric: mesh airtime link metric.
1681  * @connected_to_as: true if mesh STA has a path to authentication server
1682  */
1683 struct station_info {
1684 	u64 filled;
1685 	u32 connected_time;
1686 	u32 inactive_time;
1687 	u64 assoc_at;
1688 	u64 rx_bytes;
1689 	u64 tx_bytes;
1690 	u16 llid;
1691 	u16 plid;
1692 	u8 plink_state;
1693 	s8 signal;
1694 	s8 signal_avg;
1695 
1696 	u8 chains;
1697 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1698 	s8 chain_signal_avg[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1699 
1700 	struct rate_info txrate;
1701 	struct rate_info rxrate;
1702 	u32 rx_packets;
1703 	u32 tx_packets;
1704 	u32 tx_retries;
1705 	u32 tx_failed;
1706 	u32 rx_dropped_misc;
1707 	struct sta_bss_parameters bss_param;
1708 	struct nl80211_sta_flag_update sta_flags;
1709 
1710 	int generation;
1711 
1712 	const u8 *assoc_req_ies;
1713 	size_t assoc_req_ies_len;
1714 
1715 	u32 beacon_loss_count;
1716 	s64 t_offset;
1717 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode local_pm;
1718 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode peer_pm;
1719 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode nonpeer_pm;
1720 
1721 	u32 expected_throughput;
1722 
1723 	u64 tx_duration;
1724 	u64 rx_duration;
1725 	u64 rx_beacon;
1726 	u8 rx_beacon_signal_avg;
1727 	u8 connected_to_gate;
1728 
1729 	struct cfg80211_tid_stats *pertid;
1730 	s8 ack_signal;
1731 	s8 avg_ack_signal;
1732 
1733 	u16 airtime_weight;
1734 
1735 	u32 rx_mpdu_count;
1736 	u32 fcs_err_count;
1737 
1738 	u32 airtime_link_metric;
1739 
1740 	u8 connected_to_as;
1741 };
1742 
1743 /**
1744  * struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs - sub specs limit
1745  * @power: power limitation in 0.25dbm
1746  * @freq_range_index: index the power limitation applies to
1747  */
1748 struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs {
1749 	s32 power;
1750 	u32 freq_range_index;
1751 };
1752 
1753 /**
1754  * struct cfg80211_sar_specs - sar limit specs
1755  * @type: it's set with power in 0.25dbm or other types
1756  * @num_sub_specs: number of sar sub specs
1757  * @sub_specs: memory to hold the sar sub specs
1758  */
1759 struct cfg80211_sar_specs {
1760 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
1761 	u32 num_sub_specs;
1762 	struct cfg80211_sar_sub_specs sub_specs[];
1763 };
1764 
1765 
1766 /**
1767  * struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges - sar frequency ranges
1768  * @start_freq:  start range edge frequency
1769  * @end_freq:    end range edge frequency
1770  */
1771 struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges {
1772 	u32 start_freq;
1773 	u32 end_freq;
1774 };
1775 
1776 /**
1777  * struct cfg80211_sar_capa - sar limit capability
1778  * @type: it's set via power in 0.25dbm or other types
1779  * @num_freq_ranges: number of frequency ranges
1780  * @freq_ranges: memory to hold the freq ranges.
1781  *
1782  * Note: WLAN driver may append new ranges or split an existing
1783  * range to small ones and then append them.
1784  */
1785 struct cfg80211_sar_capa {
1786 	enum nl80211_sar_type type;
1787 	u32 num_freq_ranges;
1788 	const struct cfg80211_sar_freq_ranges *freq_ranges;
1789 };
1790 
1791 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_CFG80211)
1792 /**
1793  * cfg80211_get_station - retrieve information about a given station
1794  * @dev: the device where the station is supposed to be connected to
1795  * @mac_addr: the mac address of the station of interest
1796  * @sinfo: pointer to the structure to fill with the information
1797  *
1798  * Returns 0 on success and sinfo is filled with the available information
1799  * otherwise returns a negative error code and the content of sinfo has to be
1800  * considered undefined.
1801  */
1802 int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
1803 			 struct station_info *sinfo);
1804 #else
1805 static inline int cfg80211_get_station(struct net_device *dev,
1806 				       const u8 *mac_addr,
1807 				       struct station_info *sinfo)
1808 {
1809 	return -ENOENT;
1810 }
1811 #endif
1812 
1813 /**
1814  * enum monitor_flags - monitor flags
1815  *
1816  * Monitor interface configuration flags. Note that these must be the bits
1817  * according to the nl80211 flags.
1818  *
1819  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED: set if the flags were changed
1820  * @MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL: pass frames with bad FCS
1821  * @MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with bad PLCP
1822  * @MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL: pass control frames
1823  * @MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS: disable BSSID filtering
1824  * @MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES: report frames after processing
1825  * @MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE: active monitor, ACKs frames on its MAC address
1826  */
1827 enum monitor_flags {
1828 	MONITOR_FLAG_CHANGED		= 1<<__NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_INVALID,
1829 	MONITOR_FLAG_FCSFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_FCSFAIL,
1830 	MONITOR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_PLCPFAIL,
1831 	MONITOR_FLAG_CONTROL		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_CONTROL,
1832 	MONITOR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_OTHER_BSS,
1833 	MONITOR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES	= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_COOK_FRAMES,
1834 	MONITOR_FLAG_ACTIVE		= 1<<NL80211_MNTR_FLAG_ACTIVE,
1835 };
1836 
1837 /**
1838  * enum mpath_info_flags -  mesh path information flags
1839  *
1840  * Used by the driver to indicate which info in &struct mpath_info it has filled
1841  * in during get_station() or dump_station().
1842  *
1843  * @MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN: @frame_qlen filled
1844  * @MPATH_INFO_SN: @sn filled
1845  * @MPATH_INFO_METRIC: @metric filled
1846  * @MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME: @exptime filled
1847  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT: @discovery_timeout filled
1848  * @MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES: @discovery_retries filled
1849  * @MPATH_INFO_FLAGS: @flags filled
1850  * @MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT: @hop_count filled
1851  * @MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE: @path_change_count filled
1852  */
1853 enum mpath_info_flags {
1854 	MPATH_INFO_FRAME_QLEN		= BIT(0),
1855 	MPATH_INFO_SN			= BIT(1),
1856 	MPATH_INFO_METRIC		= BIT(2),
1857 	MPATH_INFO_EXPTIME		= BIT(3),
1858 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_TIMEOUT	= BIT(4),
1859 	MPATH_INFO_DISCOVERY_RETRIES	= BIT(5),
1860 	MPATH_INFO_FLAGS		= BIT(6),
1861 	MPATH_INFO_HOP_COUNT		= BIT(7),
1862 	MPATH_INFO_PATH_CHANGE		= BIT(8),
1863 };
1864 
1865 /**
1866  * struct mpath_info - mesh path information
1867  *
1868  * Mesh path information filled by driver for get_mpath() and dump_mpath().
1869  *
1870  * @filled: bitfield of flags from &enum mpath_info_flags
1871  * @frame_qlen: number of queued frames for this destination
1872  * @sn: target sequence number
1873  * @metric: metric (cost) of this mesh path
1874  * @exptime: expiration time for the mesh path from now, in msecs
1875  * @flags: mesh path flags
1876  * @discovery_timeout: total mesh path discovery timeout, in msecs
1877  * @discovery_retries: mesh path discovery retries
1878  * @generation: generation number for nl80211 dumps.
1879  *	This number should increase every time the list of mesh paths
1880  *	changes, i.e. when a station is added or removed, so that
1881  *	userspace can tell whether it got a consistent snapshot.
1882  * @hop_count: hops to destination
1883  * @path_change_count: total number of path changes to destination
1884  */
1885 struct mpath_info {
1886 	u32 filled;
1887 	u32 frame_qlen;
1888 	u32 sn;
1889 	u32 metric;
1890 	u32 exptime;
1891 	u32 discovery_timeout;
1892 	u8 discovery_retries;
1893 	u8 flags;
1894 	u8 hop_count;
1895 	u32 path_change_count;
1896 
1897 	int generation;
1898 };
1899 
1900 /**
1901  * struct bss_parameters - BSS parameters
1902  *
1903  * Used to change BSS parameters (mainly for AP mode).
1904  *
1905  * @use_cts_prot: Whether to use CTS protection
1906  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1907  * @use_short_preamble: Whether the use of short preambles is allowed
1908  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1909  * @use_short_slot_time: Whether the use of short slot time is allowed
1910  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1911  * @basic_rates: basic rates in IEEE 802.11 format
1912  *	(or NULL for no change)
1913  * @basic_rates_len: number of basic rates
1914  * @ap_isolate: do not forward packets between connected stations
1915  *	(0 = no, 1 = yes, -1 = do not change)
1916  * @ht_opmode: HT Operation mode
1917  *	(u16 = opmode, -1 = do not change)
1918  * @p2p_ctwindow: P2P CT Window (-1 = no change)
1919  * @p2p_opp_ps: P2P opportunistic PS (-1 = no change)
1920  */
1921 struct bss_parameters {
1922 	int use_cts_prot;
1923 	int use_short_preamble;
1924 	int use_short_slot_time;
1925 	const u8 *basic_rates;
1926 	u8 basic_rates_len;
1927 	int ap_isolate;
1928 	int ht_opmode;
1929 	s8 p2p_ctwindow, p2p_opp_ps;
1930 };
1931 
1932 /**
1933  * struct mesh_config - 802.11s mesh configuration
1934  *
1935  * These parameters can be changed while the mesh is active.
1936  *
1937  * @dot11MeshRetryTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units used
1938  *	by the Mesh Peering Open message
1939  * @dot11MeshConfirmTimeout: the initial retry timeout in millisecond units
1940  *	used by the Mesh Peering Open message
1941  * @dot11MeshHoldingTimeout: the confirm timeout in millisecond units used by
1942  *	the mesh peering management to close a mesh peering
1943  * @dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks: the maximum number of peer links allowed on this
1944  *	mesh interface
1945  * @dot11MeshMaxRetries: the maximum number of peer link open retries that can
1946  *	be sent to establish a new peer link instance in a mesh
1947  * @dot11MeshTTL: the value of TTL field set at a source mesh STA
1948  * @element_ttl: the value of TTL field set at a mesh STA for path selection
1949  *	elements
1950  * @auto_open_plinks: whether we should automatically open peer links when we
1951  *	detect compatible mesh peers
1952  * @dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor: the maximum number of neighbors to
1953  *	synchronize to for 11s default synchronization method
1954  * @dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries: the number of action frames containing a PREQ
1955  *	that an originator mesh STA can send to a particular path target
1956  * @path_refresh_time: how frequently to refresh mesh paths in milliseconds
1957  * @min_discovery_timeout: the minimum length of time to wait until giving up on
1958  *	a path discovery in milliseconds
1959  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout: the time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1960  *	receiving a PREQ shall consider the forwarding information from the
1961  *	root to be valid. (TU = time unit)
1962  * @dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1963  *	which a mesh STA can send only one action frame containing a PREQ
1964  *	element
1965  * @dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval: the minimum interval of time (in TUs) during
1966  *	which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing a PERR
1967  *	element
1968  * @dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime: the interval of time (in TUs) that
1969  *	it takes for an HWMP information element to propagate across the mesh
1970  * @dot11MeshHWMPRootMode: the configuration of a mesh STA as root mesh STA
1971  * @dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval: the interval of time (in TUs) between root
1972  *	announcements are transmitted
1973  * @dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol: whether to advertise that this mesh
1974  *	station has access to a broader network beyond the MBSS. (This is
1975  *	missnamed in draft 12.0: dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol set to true
1976  *	only means that the station will announce others it's a mesh gate, but
1977  *	not necessarily using the gate announcement protocol. Still keeping the
1978  *	same nomenclature to be in sync with the spec)
1979  * @dot11MeshForwarding: whether the Mesh STA is forwarding or non-forwarding
1980  *	entity (default is TRUE - forwarding entity)
1981  * @rssi_threshold: the threshold for average signal strength of candidate
1982  *	station to establish a peer link
1983  * @ht_opmode: mesh HT protection mode
1984  *
1985  * @dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout: The time (in TUs) for which mesh STAs
1986  *	receiving a proactive PREQ shall consider the forwarding information to
1987  *	the root mesh STA to be valid.
1988  *
1989  * @dot11MeshHWMProotInterval: The interval of time (in TUs) between proactive
1990  *	PREQs are transmitted.
1991  * @dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval: The minimum interval of time (in TUs)
1992  *	during which a mesh STA can send only one Action frame containing
1993  *	a PREQ element for root path confirmation.
1994  * @power_mode: The default mesh power save mode which will be the initial
1995  *	setting for new peer links.
1996  * @dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration: The duration in TUs the STA will remain awake
1997  *	after transmitting its beacon.
1998  * @plink_timeout: If no tx activity is seen from a STA we've established
1999  *	peering with for longer than this time (in seconds), then remove it
2000  *	from the STA's list of peers.  Default is 30 minutes.
2001  * @dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate: if set to true, advertise that this STA is
2002  *      connected to a mesh gate in mesh formation info.  If false, the
2003  *      value in mesh formation is determined by the presence of root paths
2004  *      in the mesh path table
2005  * @dot11MeshNolearn: Try to avoid multi-hop path discovery (e.g. PREQ/PREP
2006  *      for HWMP) if the destination is a direct neighbor. Note that this might
2007  *      not be the optimal decision as a multi-hop route might be better. So
2008  *      if using this setting you will likely also want to disable
2009  *      dot11MeshForwarding and use another mesh routing protocol on top.
2010  */
2011 struct mesh_config {
2012 	u16 dot11MeshRetryTimeout;
2013 	u16 dot11MeshConfirmTimeout;
2014 	u16 dot11MeshHoldingTimeout;
2015 	u16 dot11MeshMaxPeerLinks;
2016 	u8 dot11MeshMaxRetries;
2017 	u8 dot11MeshTTL;
2018 	u8 element_ttl;
2019 	bool auto_open_plinks;
2020 	u32 dot11MeshNbrOffsetMaxNeighbor;
2021 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPmaxPREQretries;
2022 	u32 path_refresh_time;
2023 	u16 min_discovery_timeout;
2024 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathTimeout;
2025 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPpreqMinInterval;
2026 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPperrMinInterval;
2027 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPnetDiameterTraversalTime;
2028 	u8 dot11MeshHWMPRootMode;
2029 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToMeshGate;
2030 	bool dot11MeshConnectedToAuthServer;
2031 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPRannInterval;
2032 	bool dot11MeshGateAnnouncementProtocol;
2033 	bool dot11MeshForwarding;
2034 	s32 rssi_threshold;
2035 	u16 ht_opmode;
2036 	u32 dot11MeshHWMPactivePathToRootTimeout;
2037 	u16 dot11MeshHWMProotInterval;
2038 	u16 dot11MeshHWMPconfirmationInterval;
2039 	enum nl80211_mesh_power_mode power_mode;
2040 	u16 dot11MeshAwakeWindowDuration;
2041 	u32 plink_timeout;
2042 	bool dot11MeshNolearn;
2043 };
2044 
2045 /**
2046  * struct mesh_setup - 802.11s mesh setup configuration
2047  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2048  * @mesh_id: the mesh ID
2049  * @mesh_id_len: length of the mesh ID, at least 1 and at most 32 bytes
2050  * @sync_method: which synchronization method to use
2051  * @path_sel_proto: which path selection protocol to use
2052  * @path_metric: which metric to use
2053  * @auth_id: which authentication method this mesh is using
2054  * @ie: vendor information elements (optional)
2055  * @ie_len: length of vendor information elements
2056  * @is_authenticated: this mesh requires authentication
2057  * @is_secure: this mesh uses security
2058  * @user_mpm: userspace handles all MPM functions
2059  * @dtim_period: DTIM period to use
2060  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2061  * @mcast_rate: multicat rate for Mesh Node [6Mbps is the default for 802.11a]
2062  * @basic_rates: basic rates to use when creating the mesh
2063  * @beacon_rate: bitrate to be used for beacons
2064  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2065  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2066  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2067  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2068  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2069  *
2070  * These parameters are fixed when the mesh is created.
2071  */
2072 struct mesh_setup {
2073 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2074 	const u8 *mesh_id;
2075 	u8 mesh_id_len;
2076 	u8 sync_method;
2077 	u8 path_sel_proto;
2078 	u8 path_metric;
2079 	u8 auth_id;
2080 	const u8 *ie;
2081 	u8 ie_len;
2082 	bool is_authenticated;
2083 	bool is_secure;
2084 	bool user_mpm;
2085 	u8 dtim_period;
2086 	u16 beacon_interval;
2087 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2088 	u32 basic_rates;
2089 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_rate;
2090 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2091 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2092 };
2093 
2094 /**
2095  * struct ocb_setup - 802.11p OCB mode setup configuration
2096  * @chandef: defines the channel to use
2097  *
2098  * These parameters are fixed when connecting to the network
2099  */
2100 struct ocb_setup {
2101 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2102 };
2103 
2104 /**
2105  * struct ieee80211_txq_params - TX queue parameters
2106  * @ac: AC identifier
2107  * @txop: Maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
2108  * @cwmin: Minimum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2109  *	1..32767]
2110  * @cwmax: Maximum contention window [a value of the form 2^n-1 in the range
2111  *	1..32767]
2112  * @aifs: Arbitration interframe space [0..255]
2113  */
2114 struct ieee80211_txq_params {
2115 	enum nl80211_ac ac;
2116 	u16 txop;
2117 	u16 cwmin;
2118 	u16 cwmax;
2119 	u8 aifs;
2120 };
2121 
2122 /**
2123  * DOC: Scanning and BSS list handling
2124  *
2125  * The scanning process itself is fairly simple, but cfg80211 offers quite
2126  * a bit of helper functionality. To start a scan, the scan operation will
2127  * be invoked with a scan definition. This scan definition contains the
2128  * channels to scan, and the SSIDs to send probe requests for (including the
2129  * wildcard, if desired). A passive scan is indicated by having no SSIDs to
2130  * probe. Additionally, a scan request may contain extra information elements
2131  * that should be added to the probe request. The IEs are guaranteed to be
2132  * well-formed, and will not exceed the maximum length the driver advertised
2133  * in the wiphy structure.
2134  *
2135  * When scanning finds a BSS, cfg80211 needs to be notified of that, because
2136  * it is responsible for maintaining the BSS list; the driver should not
2137  * maintain a list itself. For this notification, various functions exist.
2138  *
2139  * Since drivers do not maintain a BSS list, there are also a number of
2140  * functions to search for a BSS and obtain information about it from the
2141  * BSS structure cfg80211 maintains. The BSS list is also made available
2142  * to userspace.
2143  */
2144 
2145 /**
2146  * struct cfg80211_ssid - SSID description
2147  * @ssid: the SSID
2148  * @ssid_len: length of the ssid
2149  */
2150 struct cfg80211_ssid {
2151 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2152 	u8 ssid_len;
2153 };
2154 
2155 /**
2156  * struct cfg80211_scan_info - information about completed scan
2157  * @scan_start_tsf: scan start time in terms of the TSF of the BSS that the
2158  *	wireless device that requested the scan is connected to. If this
2159  *	information is not available, this field is left zero.
2160  * @tsf_bssid: the BSSID according to which %scan_start_tsf is set.
2161  * @aborted: set to true if the scan was aborted for any reason,
2162  *	userspace will be notified of that
2163  */
2164 struct cfg80211_scan_info {
2165 	u64 scan_start_tsf;
2166 	u8 tsf_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2167 	bool aborted;
2168 };
2169 
2170 /**
2171  * struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params - relevant for 6 GHz only
2172  *
2173  * @short_bssid: short ssid to scan for
2174  * @bssid: bssid to scan for
2175  * @channel_idx: idx of the channel in the channel array in the scan request
2176  *	 which the above info relvant to
2177  * @unsolicited_probe: the AP transmits unsolicited probe response every 20 TU
2178  * @short_ssid_valid: short_ssid is valid and can be used
2179  * @psc_no_listen: when set, and the channel is a PSC channel, no need to wait
2180  *       20 TUs before starting to send probe requests.
2181  */
2182 struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params {
2183 	u32 short_ssid;
2184 	u32 channel_idx;
2185 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2186 	bool unsolicited_probe;
2187 	bool short_ssid_valid;
2188 	bool psc_no_listen;
2189 };
2190 
2191 /**
2192  * struct cfg80211_scan_request - scan request description
2193  *
2194  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (active scan only)
2195  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2196  * @channels: channels to scan on.
2197  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2198  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2199  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2200  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2201  * @duration: how long to listen on each channel, in TUs. If
2202  *	%duration_mandatory is not set, this is the maximum dwell time and
2203  *	the actual dwell time may be shorter.
2204  * @duration_mandatory: if set, the scan duration must be as specified by the
2205  *	%duration field.
2206  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2207  * @rates: bitmap of rates to advertise for each band
2208  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2209  * @scan_start: time (in jiffies) when the scan started
2210  * @wdev: the wireless device to scan for
2211  * @info: (internal) information about completed scan
2212  * @notified: (internal) scan request was notified as done or aborted
2213  * @no_cck: used to send probe requests at non CCK rate in 2GHz band
2214  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2215  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2216  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2217  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2218  * @scan_6ghz: relevant for split scan request only,
2219  *	true if this is the second scan request
2220  * @n_6ghz_params: number of 6 GHz params
2221  * @scan_6ghz_params: 6 GHz params
2222  * @bssid: BSSID to scan for (most commonly, the wildcard BSSID)
2223  */
2224 struct cfg80211_scan_request {
2225 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2226 	int n_ssids;
2227 	u32 n_channels;
2228 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2229 	const u8 *ie;
2230 	size_t ie_len;
2231 	u16 duration;
2232 	bool duration_mandatory;
2233 	u32 flags;
2234 
2235 	u32 rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2236 
2237 	struct wireless_dev *wdev;
2238 
2239 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2240 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2241 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2242 
2243 	/* internal */
2244 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2245 	unsigned long scan_start;
2246 	struct cfg80211_scan_info info;
2247 	bool notified;
2248 	bool no_cck;
2249 	bool scan_6ghz;
2250 	u32 n_6ghz_params;
2251 	struct cfg80211_scan_6ghz_params *scan_6ghz_params;
2252 
2253 	/* keep last */
2254 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2255 };
2256 
2257 static inline void get_random_mask_addr(u8 *buf, const u8 *addr, const u8 *mask)
2258 {
2259 	int i;
2260 
2261 	get_random_bytes(buf, ETH_ALEN);
2262 	for (i = 0; i < ETH_ALEN; i++) {
2263 		buf[i] &= ~mask[i];
2264 		buf[i] |= addr[i] & mask[i];
2265 	}
2266 }
2267 
2268 /**
2269  * struct cfg80211_match_set - sets of attributes to match
2270  *
2271  * @ssid: SSID to be matched; may be zero-length in case of BSSID match
2272  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2273  * @bssid: BSSID to be matched; may be all-zero BSSID in case of SSID match
2274  *	or no match (RSSI only)
2275  * @rssi_thold: don't report scan results below this threshold (in s32 dBm)
2276  * @per_band_rssi_thold: Minimum rssi threshold for each band to be applied
2277  *	for filtering out scan results received. Drivers advertize this support
2278  *	of band specific rssi based filtering through the feature capability
2279  *	%NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_SCHED_SCAN_BAND_SPECIFIC_RSSI_THOLD. These band
2280  *	specific rssi thresholds take precedence over rssi_thold, if specified.
2281  *	If not specified for any band, it will be assigned with rssi_thold of
2282  *	corresponding matchset.
2283  */
2284 struct cfg80211_match_set {
2285 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
2286 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2287 	s32 rssi_thold;
2288 	s32 per_band_rssi_thold[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2289 };
2290 
2291 /**
2292  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan - scan plan for scheduled scan
2293  *
2294  * @interval: interval between scheduled scan iterations. In seconds.
2295  * @iterations: number of scan iterations in this scan plan. Zero means
2296  *	infinite loop.
2297  *	The last scan plan will always have this parameter set to zero,
2298  *	all other scan plans will have a finite number of iterations.
2299  */
2300 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan {
2301 	u32 interval;
2302 	u32 iterations;
2303 };
2304 
2305 /**
2306  * struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust - BSS selection with RSSI adjustment.
2307  *
2308  * @band: band of BSS which should match for RSSI level adjustment.
2309  * @delta: value of RSSI level adjustment.
2310  */
2311 struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust {
2312 	enum nl80211_band band;
2313 	s8 delta;
2314 };
2315 
2316 /**
2317  * struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request - scheduled scan request description
2318  *
2319  * @reqid: identifies this request.
2320  * @ssids: SSIDs to scan for (passed in the probe_reqs in active scans)
2321  * @n_ssids: number of SSIDs
2322  * @n_channels: total number of channels to scan
2323  * @scan_width: channel width for scanning
2324  * @ie: optional information element(s) to add into Probe Request or %NULL
2325  * @ie_len: length of ie in octets
2326  * @flags: bit field of flags controlling operation
2327  * @match_sets: sets of parameters to be matched for a scan result
2328  *	entry to be considered valid and to be passed to the host
2329  *	(others are filtered out).
2330  *	If ommited, all results are passed.
2331  * @n_match_sets: number of match sets
2332  * @report_results: indicates that results were reported for this request
2333  * @wiphy: the wiphy this was for
2334  * @dev: the interface
2335  * @scan_start: start time of the scheduled scan
2336  * @channels: channels to scan
2337  * @min_rssi_thold: for drivers only supporting a single threshold, this
2338  *	contains the minimum over all matchsets
2339  * @mac_addr: MAC address used with randomisation
2340  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used with randomisation, bits that
2341  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
2342  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
2343  * @scan_plans: scan plans to be executed in this scheduled scan. Lowest
2344  *	index must be executed first.
2345  * @n_scan_plans: number of scan plans, at least 1.
2346  * @rcu_head: RCU callback used to free the struct
2347  * @owner_nlportid: netlink portid of owner (if this should is a request
2348  *	owned by a particular socket)
2349  * @nl_owner_dead: netlink owner socket was closed - this request be freed
2350  * @list: for keeping list of requests.
2351  * @delay: delay in seconds to use before starting the first scan
2352  *	cycle.  The driver may ignore this parameter and start
2353  *	immediately (or at any other time), if this feature is not
2354  *	supported.
2355  * @relative_rssi_set: Indicates whether @relative_rssi is set or not.
2356  * @relative_rssi: Relative RSSI threshold in dB to restrict scan result
2357  *	reporting in connected state to cases where a matching BSS is determined
2358  *	to have better or slightly worse RSSI than the current connected BSS.
2359  *	The relative RSSI threshold values are ignored in disconnected state.
2360  * @rssi_adjust: delta dB of RSSI preference to be given to the BSSs that belong
2361  *	to the specified band while deciding whether a better BSS is reported
2362  *	using @relative_rssi. If delta is a negative number, the BSSs that
2363  *	belong to the specified band will be penalized by delta dB in relative
2364  *	comparisions.
2365  */
2366 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request {
2367 	u64 reqid;
2368 	struct cfg80211_ssid *ssids;
2369 	int n_ssids;
2370 	u32 n_channels;
2371 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2372 	const u8 *ie;
2373 	size_t ie_len;
2374 	u32 flags;
2375 	struct cfg80211_match_set *match_sets;
2376 	int n_match_sets;
2377 	s32 min_rssi_thold;
2378 	u32 delay;
2379 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_plan *scan_plans;
2380 	int n_scan_plans;
2381 
2382 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2383 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2384 
2385 	bool relative_rssi_set;
2386 	s8 relative_rssi;
2387 	struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust rssi_adjust;
2388 
2389 	/* internal */
2390 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2391 	struct net_device *dev;
2392 	unsigned long scan_start;
2393 	bool report_results;
2394 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2395 	u32 owner_nlportid;
2396 	bool nl_owner_dead;
2397 	struct list_head list;
2398 
2399 	/* keep last */
2400 	struct ieee80211_channel *channels[];
2401 };
2402 
2403 /**
2404  * enum cfg80211_signal_type - signal type
2405  *
2406  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE: no signal strength information available
2407  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM: signal strength in mBm (100*dBm)
2408  * @CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC: signal strength, increasing from 0 through 100
2409  */
2410 enum cfg80211_signal_type {
2411 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_NONE,
2412 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_MBM,
2413 	CFG80211_SIGNAL_TYPE_UNSPEC,
2414 };
2415 
2416 /**
2417  * struct cfg80211_inform_bss - BSS inform data
2418  * @chan: channel the frame was received on
2419  * @scan_width: scan width that was used
2420  * @signal: signal strength value, according to the wiphy's
2421  *	signal type
2422  * @boottime_ns: timestamp (CLOCK_BOOTTIME) when the information was
2423  *	received; should match the time when the frame was actually
2424  *	received by the device (not just by the host, in case it was
2425  *	buffered on the device) and be accurate to about 10ms.
2426  *	If the frame isn't buffered, just passing the return value of
2427  *	ktime_get_boottime_ns() is likely appropriate.
2428  * @parent_tsf: the time at the start of reception of the first octet of the
2429  *	timestamp field of the frame. The time is the TSF of the BSS specified
2430  *	by %parent_bssid.
2431  * @parent_bssid: the BSS according to which %parent_tsf is set. This is set to
2432  *	the BSS that requested the scan in which the beacon/probe was received.
2433  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2434  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2435  */
2436 struct cfg80211_inform_bss {
2437 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
2438 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2439 	s32 signal;
2440 	u64 boottime_ns;
2441 	u64 parent_tsf;
2442 	u8 parent_bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2443 	u8 chains;
2444 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2445 };
2446 
2447 /**
2448  * struct cfg80211_bss_ies - BSS entry IE data
2449  * @tsf: TSF contained in the frame that carried these IEs
2450  * @rcu_head: internal use, for freeing
2451  * @len: length of the IEs
2452  * @from_beacon: these IEs are known to come from a beacon
2453  * @data: IE data
2454  */
2455 struct cfg80211_bss_ies {
2456 	u64 tsf;
2457 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2458 	int len;
2459 	bool from_beacon;
2460 	u8 data[];
2461 };
2462 
2463 /**
2464  * struct cfg80211_bss - BSS description
2465  *
2466  * This structure describes a BSS (which may also be a mesh network)
2467  * for use in scan results and similar.
2468  *
2469  * @channel: channel this BSS is on
2470  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
2471  * @bssid: BSSID of the BSS
2472  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval as from the frame
2473  * @capability: the capability field in host byte order
2474  * @ies: the information elements (Note that there is no guarantee that these
2475  *	are well-formed!); this is a pointer to either the beacon_ies or
2476  *	proberesp_ies depending on whether Probe Response frame has been
2477  *	received. It is always non-%NULL.
2478  * @beacon_ies: the information elements from the last Beacon frame
2479  *	(implementation note: if @hidden_beacon_bss is set this struct doesn't
2480  *	own the beacon_ies, but they're just pointers to the ones from the
2481  *	@hidden_beacon_bss struct)
2482  * @proberesp_ies: the information elements from the last Probe Response frame
2483  * @hidden_beacon_bss: in case this BSS struct represents a probe response from
2484  *	a BSS that hides the SSID in its beacon, this points to the BSS struct
2485  *	that holds the beacon data. @beacon_ies is still valid, of course, and
2486  *	points to the same data as hidden_beacon_bss->beacon_ies in that case.
2487  * @transmitted_bss: pointer to the transmitted BSS, if this is a
2488  *	non-transmitted one (multi-BSSID support)
2489  * @nontrans_list: list of non-transmitted BSS, if this is a transmitted one
2490  *	(multi-BSSID support)
2491  * @signal: signal strength value (type depends on the wiphy's signal_type)
2492  * @chains: bitmask for filled values in @chain_signal.
2493  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength of last received BSS in dBm.
2494  * @bssid_index: index in the multiple BSS set
2495  * @max_bssid_indicator: max number of members in the BSS set
2496  * @priv: private area for driver use, has at least wiphy->bss_priv_size bytes
2497  */
2498 struct cfg80211_bss {
2499 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2500 	enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width;
2501 
2502 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *ies;
2503 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *beacon_ies;
2504 	const struct cfg80211_bss_ies __rcu *proberesp_ies;
2505 
2506 	struct cfg80211_bss *hidden_beacon_bss;
2507 	struct cfg80211_bss *transmitted_bss;
2508 	struct list_head nontrans_list;
2509 
2510 	s32 signal;
2511 
2512 	u16 beacon_interval;
2513 	u16 capability;
2514 
2515 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
2516 	u8 chains;
2517 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
2518 
2519 	u8 bssid_index;
2520 	u8 max_bssid_indicator;
2521 
2522 	u8 priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2523 };
2524 
2525 /**
2526  * ieee80211_bss_get_elem - find element with given ID
2527  * @bss: the bss to search
2528  * @id: the element ID
2529  *
2530  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2531  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2532  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2533  */
2534 const struct element *ieee80211_bss_get_elem(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id);
2535 
2536 /**
2537  * ieee80211_bss_get_ie - find IE with given ID
2538  * @bss: the bss to search
2539  * @id: the element ID
2540  *
2541  * Note that the return value is an RCU-protected pointer, so
2542  * rcu_read_lock() must be held when calling this function.
2543  * Return: %NULL if not found.
2544  */
2545 static inline const u8 *ieee80211_bss_get_ie(struct cfg80211_bss *bss, u8 id)
2546 {
2547 	return (void *)ieee80211_bss_get_elem(bss, id);
2548 }
2549 
2550 
2551 /**
2552  * struct cfg80211_auth_request - Authentication request data
2553  *
2554  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2555  * authentication.
2556  *
2557  * @bss: The BSS to authenticate with, the callee must obtain a reference
2558  *	to it if it needs to keep it.
2559  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2560  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Authentication frame or %NULL
2561  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2562  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2563  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2564  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2565  * @auth_data: Fields and elements in Authentication frames. This contains
2566  *	the authentication frame body (non-IE and IE data), excluding the
2567  *	Authentication algorithm number, i.e., starting at the Authentication
2568  *	transaction sequence number field.
2569  * @auth_data_len: Length of auth_data buffer in octets
2570  */
2571 struct cfg80211_auth_request {
2572 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2573 	const u8 *ie;
2574 	size_t ie_len;
2575 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2576 	const u8 *key;
2577 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2578 	const u8 *auth_data;
2579 	size_t auth_data_len;
2580 };
2581 
2582 /**
2583  * enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags - Over-ride default behaviour in association.
2584  *
2585  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT:  Disable HT (802.11n)
2586  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT:  Disable VHT
2587  * @ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM: Declare RRM capability in this association
2588  * @CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT: User space indicates external
2589  *	authentication capability. Drivers can offload authentication to
2590  *	userspace if this flag is set. Only applicable for cfg80211_connect()
2591  *	request (connect callback).
2592  * @ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE:  Disable HE
2593  */
2594 enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags {
2595 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HT			= BIT(0),
2596 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_VHT			= BIT(1),
2597 	ASSOC_REQ_USE_RRM			= BIT(2),
2598 	CONNECT_REQ_EXTERNAL_AUTH_SUPPORT	= BIT(3),
2599 	ASSOC_REQ_DISABLE_HE			= BIT(4),
2600 };
2601 
2602 /**
2603  * struct cfg80211_assoc_request - (Re)Association request data
2604  *
2605  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2606  * (re)association.
2607  * @bss: The BSS to associate with. If the call is successful the driver is
2608  *	given a reference that it must give back to cfg80211_send_rx_assoc()
2609  *	or to cfg80211_assoc_timeout(). To ensure proper refcounting, new
2610  *	association requests while already associating must be rejected.
2611  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to (Re)Association Request frame or %NULL
2612  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2613  * @use_mfp: Use management frame protection (IEEE 802.11w) in this association
2614  * @crypto: crypto settings
2615  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2616  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2617  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2618  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2619  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2620  *	frame.
2621  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2622  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2623  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2624  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2625  * @vht_capa: VHT capability override
2626  * @vht_capa_mask: VHT capability mask indicating which fields to use
2627  * @fils_kek: FILS KEK for protecting (Re)Association Request/Response frame or
2628  *	%NULL if FILS is not used.
2629  * @fils_kek_len: Length of fils_kek in octets
2630  * @fils_nonces: FILS nonces (part of AAD) for protecting (Re)Association
2631  *	Request/Response frame or %NULL if FILS is not used. This field starts
2632  *	with 16 octets of STA Nonce followed by 16 octets of AP Nonce.
2633  * @s1g_capa: S1G capability override
2634  * @s1g_capa_mask: S1G capability override mask
2635  */
2636 struct cfg80211_assoc_request {
2637 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2638 	const u8 *ie, *prev_bssid;
2639 	size_t ie_len;
2640 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2641 	bool use_mfp;
2642 	u32 flags;
2643 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2644 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2645 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa, vht_capa_mask;
2646 	const u8 *fils_kek;
2647 	size_t fils_kek_len;
2648 	const u8 *fils_nonces;
2649 	struct ieee80211_s1g_cap s1g_capa, s1g_capa_mask;
2650 };
2651 
2652 /**
2653  * struct cfg80211_deauth_request - Deauthentication request data
2654  *
2655  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2656  * deauthentication.
2657  *
2658  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS to deauthenticate from
2659  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Deauthentication frame or %NULL
2660  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2661  * @reason_code: The reason code for the deauthentication
2662  * @local_state_change: if set, change local state only and
2663  *	do not set a deauth frame
2664  */
2665 struct cfg80211_deauth_request {
2666 	const u8 *bssid;
2667 	const u8 *ie;
2668 	size_t ie_len;
2669 	u16 reason_code;
2670 	bool local_state_change;
2671 };
2672 
2673 /**
2674  * struct cfg80211_disassoc_request - Disassociation request data
2675  *
2676  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2677  * disassociation.
2678  *
2679  * @bss: the BSS to disassociate from
2680  * @ie: Extra IEs to add to Disassociation frame or %NULL
2681  * @ie_len: Length of ie buffer in octets
2682  * @reason_code: The reason code for the disassociation
2683  * @local_state_change: This is a request for a local state only, i.e., no
2684  *	Disassociation frame is to be transmitted.
2685  */
2686 struct cfg80211_disassoc_request {
2687 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
2688 	const u8 *ie;
2689 	size_t ie_len;
2690 	u16 reason_code;
2691 	bool local_state_change;
2692 };
2693 
2694 /**
2695  * struct cfg80211_ibss_params - IBSS parameters
2696  *
2697  * This structure defines the IBSS parameters for the join_ibss()
2698  * method.
2699  *
2700  * @ssid: The SSID, will always be non-null.
2701  * @ssid_len: The length of the SSID, will always be non-zero.
2702  * @bssid: Fixed BSSID requested, maybe be %NULL, if set do not
2703  *	search for IBSSs with a different BSSID.
2704  * @chandef: defines the channel to use if no other IBSS to join can be found
2705  * @channel_fixed: The channel should be fixed -- do not search for
2706  *	IBSSs to join on other channels.
2707  * @ie: information element(s) to include in the beacon
2708  * @ie_len: length of that
2709  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval to use
2710  * @privacy: this is a protected network, keys will be configured
2711  *	after joining
2712  * @control_port: whether user space controls IEEE 802.1X port, i.e.,
2713  *	sets/clears %NL80211_STA_FLAG_AUTHORIZED. If true, the driver is
2714  *	required to assume that the port is unauthorized until authorized by
2715  *	user space. Otherwise, port is marked authorized by default.
2716  * @control_port_over_nl80211: TRUE if userspace expects to exchange control
2717  *	port frames over NL80211 instead of the network interface.
2718  * @userspace_handles_dfs: whether user space controls DFS operation, i.e.
2719  *	changes the channel when a radar is detected. This is required
2720  *	to operate on DFS channels.
2721  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates to use when creating the IBSS
2722  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
2723  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2724  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2725  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2726  * @wep_keys: static WEP keys, if not NULL points to an array of
2727  *	CFG80211_MAX_WEP_KEYS WEP keys
2728  * @wep_tx_key: key index (0..3) of the default TX static WEP key
2729  */
2730 struct cfg80211_ibss_params {
2731 	const u8 *ssid;
2732 	const u8 *bssid;
2733 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
2734 	const u8 *ie;
2735 	u8 ssid_len, ie_len;
2736 	u16 beacon_interval;
2737 	u32 basic_rates;
2738 	bool channel_fixed;
2739 	bool privacy;
2740 	bool control_port;
2741 	bool control_port_over_nl80211;
2742 	bool userspace_handles_dfs;
2743 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2744 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2745 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2746 	struct key_params *wep_keys;
2747 	int wep_tx_key;
2748 };
2749 
2750 /**
2751  * struct cfg80211_bss_selection - connection parameters for BSS selection.
2752  *
2753  * @behaviour: requested BSS selection behaviour.
2754  * @param: parameters for requestion behaviour.
2755  * @band_pref: preferred band for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_BAND_PREF.
2756  * @adjust: parameters for %NL80211_BSS_SELECT_ATTR_RSSI_ADJUST.
2757  */
2758 struct cfg80211_bss_selection {
2759 	enum nl80211_bss_select_attr behaviour;
2760 	union {
2761 		enum nl80211_band band_pref;
2762 		struct cfg80211_bss_select_adjust adjust;
2763 	} param;
2764 };
2765 
2766 /**
2767  * struct cfg80211_connect_params - Connection parameters
2768  *
2769  * This structure provides information needed to complete IEEE 802.11
2770  * authentication and association.
2771  *
2772  * @channel: The channel to use or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based
2773  *	on scan results)
2774  * @channel_hint: The channel of the recommended BSS for initial connection or
2775  *	%NULL if not specified
2776  * @bssid: The AP BSSID or %NULL if not specified (auto-select based on scan
2777  *	results)
2778  * @bssid_hint: The recommended AP BSSID for initial connection to the BSS or
2779  *	%NULL if not specified. Unlike the @bssid parameter, the driver is
2780  *	allowed to ignore this @bssid_hint if it has knowledge of a better BSS
2781  *	to use.
2782  * @ssid: SSID
2783  * @ssid_len: Length of ssid in octets
2784  * @auth_type: Authentication type (algorithm)
2785  * @ie: IEs for association request
2786  * @ie_len: Length of assoc_ie in octets
2787  * @privacy: indicates whether privacy-enabled APs should be used
2788  * @mfp: indicate whether management frame protection is used
2789  * @crypto: crypto settings
2790  * @key_len: length of WEP key for shared key authentication
2791  * @key_idx: index of WEP key for shared key authentication
2792  * @key: WEP key for shared key authentication
2793  * @flags:  See &enum cfg80211_assoc_req_flags
2794  * @bg_scan_period:  Background scan period in seconds
2795  *	or -1 to indicate that default value is to be used.
2796  * @ht_capa:  HT Capabilities over-rides.  Values set in ht_capa_mask
2797  *	will be used in ht_capa.  Un-supported values will be ignored.
2798  * @ht_capa_mask:  The bits of ht_capa which are to be used.
2799  * @vht_capa:  VHT Capability overrides
2800  * @vht_capa_mask: The bits of vht_capa which are to be used.
2801  * @pbss: if set, connect to a PCP instead of AP. Valid for DMG
2802  *	networks.
2803  * @bss_select: criteria to be used for BSS selection.
2804  * @prev_bssid: previous BSSID, if not %NULL use reassociate frame. This is used
2805  *	to indicate a request to reassociate within the ESS instead of a request
2806  *	do the initial association with the ESS. When included, this is set to
2807  *	the BSSID of the current association, i.e., to the value that is
2808  *	included in the Current AP address field of the Reassociation Request
2809  *	frame.
2810  * @fils_erp_username: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) username part of the
2811  *	NAI or %NULL if not specified. This is used to construct FILS wrapped
2812  *	data IE.
2813  * @fils_erp_username_len: Length of @fils_erp_username in octets.
2814  * @fils_erp_realm: EAP re-authentication protocol (ERP) realm part of NAI or
2815  *	%NULL if not specified. This specifies the domain name of ER server and
2816  *	is used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2817  * @fils_erp_realm_len: Length of @fils_erp_realm in octets.
2818  * @fils_erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in the FILS ERP
2819  *	messages. This is also used to construct FILS wrapped data IE.
2820  * @fils_erp_rrk: ERP re-authentication Root Key (rRK) used to derive additional
2821  *	keys in FILS or %NULL if not specified.
2822  * @fils_erp_rrk_len: Length of @fils_erp_rrk in octets.
2823  * @want_1x: indicates user-space supports and wants to use 802.1X driver
2824  *	offload of 4-way handshake.
2825  * @edmg: define the EDMG channels.
2826  *	This may specify multiple channels and bonding options for the driver
2827  *	to choose from, based on BSS configuration.
2828  */
2829 struct cfg80211_connect_params {
2830 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
2831 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel_hint;
2832 	const u8 *bssid;
2833 	const u8 *bssid_hint;
2834 	const u8 *ssid;
2835 	size_t ssid_len;
2836 	enum nl80211_auth_type auth_type;
2837 	const u8 *ie;
2838 	size_t ie_len;
2839 	bool privacy;
2840 	enum nl80211_mfp mfp;
2841 	struct cfg80211_crypto_settings crypto;
2842 	const u8 *key;
2843 	u8 key_len, key_idx;
2844 	u32 flags;
2845 	int bg_scan_period;
2846 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa;
2847 	struct ieee80211_ht_cap ht_capa_mask;
2848 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa;
2849 	struct ieee80211_vht_cap vht_capa_mask;
2850 	bool pbss;
2851 	struct cfg80211_bss_selection bss_select;
2852 	const u8 *prev_bssid;
2853 	const u8 *fils_erp_username;
2854 	size_t fils_erp_username_len;
2855 	const u8 *fils_erp_realm;
2856 	size_t fils_erp_realm_len;
2857 	u16 fils_erp_next_seq_num;
2858 	const u8 *fils_erp_rrk;
2859 	size_t fils_erp_rrk_len;
2860 	bool want_1x;
2861 	struct ieee80211_edmg edmg;
2862 };
2863 
2864 /**
2865  * enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed - Connection parameters being updated
2866  *
2867  * This enum provides information of all connect parameters that
2868  * have to be updated as part of update_connect_params() call.
2869  *
2870  * @UPDATE_ASSOC_IES: Indicates whether association request IEs are updated
2871  * @UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO: Indicates that FILS connection parameters (realm,
2872  *	username, erp sequence number and rrk) are updated
2873  * @UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE: Indicates that authentication type is updated
2874  */
2875 enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed {
2876 	UPDATE_ASSOC_IES		= BIT(0),
2877 	UPDATE_FILS_ERP_INFO		= BIT(1),
2878 	UPDATE_AUTH_TYPE		= BIT(2),
2879 };
2880 
2881 /**
2882  * enum wiphy_params_flags - set_wiphy_params bitfield values
2883  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT: wiphy->retry_short has changed
2884  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG: wiphy->retry_long has changed
2885  * @WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD: wiphy->frag_threshold has changed
2886  * @WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD: wiphy->rts_threshold has changed
2887  * @WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS: coverage class changed
2888  * @WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK: dynack has been enabled
2889  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT: TXQ packet limit has been changed
2890  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT: TXQ memory limit has been changed
2891  * @WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM: TXQ scheduler quantum
2892  */
2893 enum wiphy_params_flags {
2894 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_SHORT		= 1 << 0,
2895 	WIPHY_PARAM_RETRY_LONG		= 1 << 1,
2896 	WIPHY_PARAM_FRAG_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 2,
2897 	WIPHY_PARAM_RTS_THRESHOLD	= 1 << 3,
2898 	WIPHY_PARAM_COVERAGE_CLASS	= 1 << 4,
2899 	WIPHY_PARAM_DYN_ACK		= 1 << 5,
2900 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_LIMIT		= 1 << 6,
2901 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_MEMORY_LIMIT	= 1 << 7,
2902 	WIPHY_PARAM_TXQ_QUANTUM		= 1 << 8,
2903 };
2904 
2905 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AIRTIME_WEIGHT	256
2906 
2907 /* The per TXQ device queue limit in airtime */
2908 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_L	5000
2909 #define IEEE80211_DEFAULT_AQL_TXQ_LIMIT_H	12000
2910 
2911 /* The per interface airtime threshold to switch to lower queue limit */
2912 #define IEEE80211_AQL_THRESHOLD			24000
2913 
2914 /**
2915  * struct cfg80211_pmksa - PMK Security Association
2916  *
2917  * This structure is passed to the set/del_pmksa() method for PMKSA
2918  * caching.
2919  *
2920  * @bssid: The AP's BSSID (may be %NULL).
2921  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
2922  * @pmk: The PMK for the PMKSA identified by @pmkid. This is used for key
2923  *	derivation by a FILS STA. Otherwise, %NULL.
2924  * @pmk_len: Length of the @pmk. The length of @pmk can differ depending on
2925  *	the hash algorithm used to generate this.
2926  * @ssid: SSID to specify the ESS within which a PMKSA is valid when using FILS
2927  *	cache identifier (may be %NULL).
2928  * @ssid_len: Length of the @ssid in octets.
2929  * @cache_id: 2-octet cache identifier advertized by a FILS AP identifying the
2930  *	scope of PMKSA. This is valid only if @ssid_len is non-zero (may be
2931  *	%NULL).
2932  * @pmk_lifetime: Maximum lifetime for PMKSA in seconds
2933  *	(dot11RSNAConfigPMKLifetime) or 0 if not specified.
2934  *	The configured PMKSA must not be used for PMKSA caching after
2935  *	expiration and any keys derived from this PMK become invalid on
2936  *	expiration, i.e., the current association must be dropped if the PMK
2937  *	used for it expires.
2938  * @pmk_reauth_threshold: Threshold time for reauthentication (percentage of
2939  *	PMK lifetime, dot11RSNAConfigPMKReauthThreshold) or 0 if not specified.
2940  *	Drivers are expected to trigger a full authentication instead of using
2941  *	this PMKSA for caching when reassociating to a new BSS after this
2942  *	threshold to generate a new PMK before the current one expires.
2943  */
2944 struct cfg80211_pmksa {
2945 	const u8 *bssid;
2946 	const u8 *pmkid;
2947 	const u8 *pmk;
2948 	size_t pmk_len;
2949 	const u8 *ssid;
2950 	size_t ssid_len;
2951 	const u8 *cache_id;
2952 	u32 pmk_lifetime;
2953 	u8 pmk_reauth_threshold;
2954 };
2955 
2956 /**
2957  * struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern - packet pattern
2958  * @mask: bitmask where to match pattern and where to ignore bytes,
2959  *	one bit per byte, in same format as nl80211
2960  * @pattern: bytes to match where bitmask is 1
2961  * @pattern_len: length of pattern (in bytes)
2962  * @pkt_offset: packet offset (in bytes)
2963  *
2964  * Internal note: @mask and @pattern are allocated in one chunk of
2965  * memory, free @mask only!
2966  */
2967 struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern {
2968 	const u8 *mask, *pattern;
2969 	int pattern_len;
2970 	int pkt_offset;
2971 };
2972 
2973 /**
2974  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp - TCP connection parameters
2975  *
2976  * @sock: (internal) socket for source port allocation
2977  * @src: source IP address
2978  * @dst: destination IP address
2979  * @dst_mac: destination MAC address
2980  * @src_port: source port
2981  * @dst_port: destination port
2982  * @payload_len: data payload length
2983  * @payload: data payload buffer
2984  * @payload_seq: payload sequence stamping configuration
2985  * @data_interval: interval at which to send data packets
2986  * @wake_len: wakeup payload match length
2987  * @wake_data: wakeup payload match data
2988  * @wake_mask: wakeup payload match mask
2989  * @tokens_size: length of the tokens buffer
2990  * @payload_tok: payload token usage configuration
2991  */
2992 struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp {
2993 	struct socket *sock;
2994 	__be32 src, dst;
2995 	u16 src_port, dst_port;
2996 	u8 dst_mac[ETH_ALEN];
2997 	int payload_len;
2998 	const u8 *payload;
2999 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_seq payload_seq;
3000 	u32 data_interval;
3001 	u32 wake_len;
3002 	const u8 *wake_data, *wake_mask;
3003 	u32 tokens_size;
3004 	/* must be last, variable member */
3005 	struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token payload_tok;
3006 };
3007 
3008 /**
3009  * struct cfg80211_wowlan - Wake on Wireless-LAN support info
3010  *
3011  * This structure defines the enabled WoWLAN triggers for the device.
3012  * @any: wake up on any activity -- special trigger if device continues
3013  *	operating as normal during suspend
3014  * @disconnect: wake up if getting disconnected
3015  * @magic_pkt: wake up on receiving magic packet
3016  * @patterns: wake up on receiving packet matching a pattern
3017  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3018  * @gtk_rekey_failure: wake up on GTK rekey failure
3019  * @eap_identity_req: wake up on EAP identity request packet
3020  * @four_way_handshake: wake up on 4-way handshake
3021  * @rfkill_release: wake up when rfkill is released
3022  * @tcp: TCP connection establishment/wakeup parameters, see nl80211.h.
3023  *	NULL if not configured.
3024  * @nd_config: configuration for the scan to be used for net detect wake.
3025  */
3026 struct cfg80211_wowlan {
3027 	bool any, disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3028 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3029 	     rfkill_release;
3030 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3031 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_tcp *tcp;
3032 	int n_patterns;
3033 	struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *nd_config;
3034 };
3035 
3036 /**
3037  * struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules - Coalesce rule parameters
3038  *
3039  * This structure defines coalesce rule for the device.
3040  * @delay: maximum coalescing delay in msecs.
3041  * @condition: condition for packet coalescence.
3042  *	see &enum nl80211_coalesce_condition.
3043  * @patterns: array of packet patterns
3044  * @n_patterns: number of patterns
3045  */
3046 struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules {
3047 	int delay;
3048 	enum nl80211_coalesce_condition condition;
3049 	struct cfg80211_pkt_pattern *patterns;
3050 	int n_patterns;
3051 };
3052 
3053 /**
3054  * struct cfg80211_coalesce - Packet coalescing settings
3055  *
3056  * This structure defines coalescing settings.
3057  * @rules: array of coalesce rules
3058  * @n_rules: number of rules
3059  */
3060 struct cfg80211_coalesce {
3061 	struct cfg80211_coalesce_rules *rules;
3062 	int n_rules;
3063 };
3064 
3065 /**
3066  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match - information about the match
3067  *
3068  * @ssid: SSID of the match that triggered the wake up
3069  * @n_channels: Number of channels where the match occurred.  This
3070  *	value may be zero if the driver can't report the channels.
3071  * @channels: center frequencies of the channels where a match
3072  *	occurred (in MHz)
3073  */
3074 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match {
3075 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3076 	int n_channels;
3077 	u32 channels[];
3078 };
3079 
3080 /**
3081  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info - net detect wake up information
3082  *
3083  * @n_matches: Number of match information instances provided in
3084  *	@matches.  This value may be zero if the driver can't provide
3085  *	match information.
3086  * @matches: Array of pointers to matches containing information about
3087  *	the matches that triggered the wake up.
3088  */
3089 struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info {
3090 	int n_matches;
3091 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_match *matches[];
3092 };
3093 
3094 /**
3095  * struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup - wakeup report
3096  * @disconnect: woke up by getting disconnected
3097  * @magic_pkt: woke up by receiving magic packet
3098  * @gtk_rekey_failure: woke up by GTK rekey failure
3099  * @eap_identity_req: woke up by EAP identity request packet
3100  * @four_way_handshake: woke up by 4-way handshake
3101  * @rfkill_release: woke up by rfkill being released
3102  * @pattern_idx: pattern that caused wakeup, -1 if not due to pattern
3103  * @packet_present_len: copied wakeup packet data
3104  * @packet_len: original wakeup packet length
3105  * @packet: The packet causing the wakeup, if any.
3106  * @packet_80211:  For pattern match, magic packet and other data
3107  *	frame triggers an 802.3 frame should be reported, for
3108  *	disconnect due to deauth 802.11 frame. This indicates which
3109  *	it is.
3110  * @tcp_match: TCP wakeup packet received
3111  * @tcp_connlost: TCP connection lost or failed to establish
3112  * @tcp_nomoretokens: TCP data ran out of tokens
3113  * @net_detect: if not %NULL, woke up because of net detect
3114  */
3115 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup {
3116 	bool disconnect, magic_pkt, gtk_rekey_failure,
3117 	     eap_identity_req, four_way_handshake,
3118 	     rfkill_release, packet_80211,
3119 	     tcp_match, tcp_connlost, tcp_nomoretokens;
3120 	s32 pattern_idx;
3121 	u32 packet_present_len, packet_len;
3122 	const void *packet;
3123 	struct cfg80211_wowlan_nd_info *net_detect;
3124 };
3125 
3126 /**
3127  * struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data - rekey data
3128  * @kek: key encryption key (@kek_len bytes)
3129  * @kck: key confirmation key (@kck_len bytes)
3130  * @replay_ctr: replay counter (NL80211_REPLAY_CTR_LEN bytes)
3131  * @kek_len: length of kek
3132  * @kck_len length of kck
3133  * @akm: akm (oui, id)
3134  */
3135 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data {
3136 	const u8 *kek, *kck, *replay_ctr;
3137 	u32 akm;
3138 	u8 kek_len, kck_len;
3139 };
3140 
3141 /**
3142  * struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params - FT IE Information
3143  *
3144  * This structure provides information needed to update the fast transition IE
3145  *
3146  * @md: The Mobility Domain ID, 2 Octet value
3147  * @ie: Fast Transition IEs
3148  * @ie_len: Length of ft_ie in octets
3149  */
3150 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params {
3151 	u16 md;
3152 	const u8 *ie;
3153 	size_t ie_len;
3154 };
3155 
3156 /**
3157  * struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params - mgmt tx parameters
3158  *
3159  * This structure provides information needed to transmit a mgmt frame
3160  *
3161  * @chan: channel to use
3162  * @offchan: indicates wether off channel operation is required
3163  * @wait: duration for ROC
3164  * @buf: buffer to transmit
3165  * @len: buffer length
3166  * @no_cck: don't use cck rates for this frame
3167  * @dont_wait_for_ack: tells the low level not to wait for an ack
3168  * @n_csa_offsets: length of csa_offsets array
3169  * @csa_offsets: array of all the csa offsets in the frame
3170  */
3171 struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params {
3172 	struct ieee80211_channel *chan;
3173 	bool offchan;
3174 	unsigned int wait;
3175 	const u8 *buf;
3176 	size_t len;
3177 	bool no_cck;
3178 	bool dont_wait_for_ack;
3179 	int n_csa_offsets;
3180 	const u16 *csa_offsets;
3181 };
3182 
3183 /**
3184  * struct cfg80211_dscp_exception - DSCP exception
3185  *
3186  * @dscp: DSCP value that does not adhere to the user priority range definition
3187  * @up: user priority value to which the corresponding DSCP value belongs
3188  */
3189 struct cfg80211_dscp_exception {
3190 	u8 dscp;
3191 	u8 up;
3192 };
3193 
3194 /**
3195  * struct cfg80211_dscp_range - DSCP range definition for user priority
3196  *
3197  * @low: lowest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3198  * @high: highest DSCP value of this user priority range, inclusive
3199  */
3200 struct cfg80211_dscp_range {
3201 	u8 low;
3202 	u8 high;
3203 };
3204 
3205 /* QoS Map Set element length defined in IEEE Std 802.11-2012, 8.4.2.97 */
3206 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX	21
3207 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN	16
3208 #define IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MAX \
3209 	(IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_LEN_MIN + 2 * IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX)
3210 
3211 /**
3212  * struct cfg80211_qos_map - QoS Map Information
3213  *
3214  * This struct defines the Interworking QoS map setting for DSCP values
3215  *
3216  * @num_des: number of DSCP exceptions (0..21)
3217  * @dscp_exception: optionally up to maximum of 21 DSCP exceptions from
3218  *	the user priority DSCP range definition
3219  * @up: DSCP range definition for a particular user priority
3220  */
3221 struct cfg80211_qos_map {
3222 	u8 num_des;
3223 	struct cfg80211_dscp_exception dscp_exception[IEEE80211_QOS_MAP_MAX_EX];
3224 	struct cfg80211_dscp_range up[8];
3225 };
3226 
3227 /**
3228  * struct cfg80211_nan_conf - NAN configuration
3229  *
3230  * This struct defines NAN configuration parameters
3231  *
3232  * @master_pref: master preference (1 - 255)
3233  * @bands: operating bands, a bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.
3234  *	For instance, for NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
3235  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
3236  */
3237 struct cfg80211_nan_conf {
3238 	u8 master_pref;
3239 	u8 bands;
3240 };
3241 
3242 /**
3243  * enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes - indicates changed fields in NAN
3244  * configuration
3245  *
3246  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF: master preference
3247  * @CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS: operating bands
3248  */
3249 enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes {
3250 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_PREF = BIT(0),
3251 	CFG80211_NAN_CONF_CHANGED_BANDS = BIT(1),
3252 };
3253 
3254 /**
3255  * struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter - a NAN function Rx / Tx filter
3256  *
3257  * @filter: the content of the filter
3258  * @len: the length of the filter
3259  */
3260 struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter {
3261 	const u8 *filter;
3262 	u8 len;
3263 };
3264 
3265 /**
3266  * struct cfg80211_nan_func - a NAN function
3267  *
3268  * @type: &enum nl80211_nan_function_type
3269  * @service_id: the service ID of the function
3270  * @publish_type: &nl80211_nan_publish_type
3271  * @close_range: if true, the range should be limited. Threshold is
3272  *	implementation specific.
3273  * @publish_bcast: if true, the solicited publish should be broadcasted
3274  * @subscribe_active: if true, the subscribe is active
3275  * @followup_id: the instance ID for follow up
3276  * @followup_reqid: the requestor instance ID for follow up
3277  * @followup_dest: MAC address of the recipient of the follow up
3278  * @ttl: time to live counter in DW.
3279  * @serv_spec_info: Service Specific Info
3280  * @serv_spec_info_len: Service Specific Info length
3281  * @srf_include: if true, SRF is inclusive
3282  * @srf_bf: Bloom Filter
3283  * @srf_bf_len: Bloom Filter length
3284  * @srf_bf_idx: Bloom Filter index
3285  * @srf_macs: SRF MAC addresses
3286  * @srf_num_macs: number of MAC addresses in SRF
3287  * @rx_filters: rx filters that are matched with corresponding peer's tx_filter
3288  * @tx_filters: filters that should be transmitted in the SDF.
3289  * @num_rx_filters: length of &rx_filters.
3290  * @num_tx_filters: length of &tx_filters.
3291  * @instance_id: driver allocated id of the function.
3292  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier.
3293  */
3294 struct cfg80211_nan_func {
3295 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
3296 	u8 service_id[NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SERVICE_ID_LEN];
3297 	u8 publish_type;
3298 	bool close_range;
3299 	bool publish_bcast;
3300 	bool subscribe_active;
3301 	u8 followup_id;
3302 	u8 followup_reqid;
3303 	struct mac_address followup_dest;
3304 	u32 ttl;
3305 	const u8 *serv_spec_info;
3306 	u8 serv_spec_info_len;
3307 	bool srf_include;
3308 	const u8 *srf_bf;
3309 	u8 srf_bf_len;
3310 	u8 srf_bf_idx;
3311 	struct mac_address *srf_macs;
3312 	int srf_num_macs;
3313 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *rx_filters;
3314 	struct cfg80211_nan_func_filter *tx_filters;
3315 	u8 num_tx_filters;
3316 	u8 num_rx_filters;
3317 	u8 instance_id;
3318 	u64 cookie;
3319 };
3320 
3321 /**
3322  * struct cfg80211_pmk_conf - PMK configuration
3323  *
3324  * @aa: authenticator address
3325  * @pmk_len: PMK length in bytes.
3326  * @pmk: the PMK material
3327  * @pmk_r0_name: PMK-R0 Name. NULL if not applicable (i.e., the PMK
3328  *	is not PMK-R0). When pmk_r0_name is not NULL, the pmk field
3329  *	holds PMK-R0.
3330  */
3331 struct cfg80211_pmk_conf {
3332 	const u8 *aa;
3333 	u8 pmk_len;
3334 	const u8 *pmk;
3335 	const u8 *pmk_r0_name;
3336 };
3337 
3338 /**
3339  * struct cfg80211_external_auth_params - Trigger External authentication.
3340  *
3341  * Commonly used across the external auth request and event interfaces.
3342  *
3343  * @action: action type / trigger for external authentication. Only significant
3344  *	for the authentication request event interface (driver to user space).
3345  * @bssid: BSSID of the peer with which the authentication has
3346  *	to happen. Used by both the authentication request event and
3347  *	authentication response command interface.
3348  * @ssid: SSID of the AP.  Used by both the authentication request event and
3349  *	authentication response command interface.
3350  * @key_mgmt_suite: AKM suite of the respective authentication. Used by the
3351  *	authentication request event interface.
3352  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful authentication,
3353  *	use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space cannot give you
3354  *	the real status code for failures. Used only for the authentication
3355  *	response command interface (user space to driver).
3356  * @pmkid: The identifier to refer a PMKSA.
3357  */
3358 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params {
3359 	enum nl80211_external_auth_action action;
3360 	u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3361 	struct cfg80211_ssid ssid;
3362 	unsigned int key_mgmt_suite;
3363 	u16 status;
3364 	const u8 *pmkid;
3365 };
3366 
3367 /**
3368  * struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats - FTM responder statistics
3369  *
3370  * @filled: bitflag of flags using the bits of &enum nl80211_ftm_stats to
3371  *	indicate the relevant values in this struct for them
3372  * @success_num: number of FTM sessions in which all frames were successfully
3373  *	answered
3374  * @partial_num: number of FTM sessions in which part of frames were
3375  *	successfully answered
3376  * @failed_num: number of failed FTM sessions
3377  * @asap_num: number of ASAP FTM sessions
3378  * @non_asap_num: number of  non-ASAP FTM sessions
3379  * @total_duration_ms: total sessions durations - gives an indication
3380  *	of how much time the responder was busy
3381  * @unknown_triggers_num: number of unknown FTM triggers - triggers from
3382  *	initiators that didn't finish successfully the negotiation phase with
3383  *	the responder
3384  * @reschedule_requests_num: number of FTM reschedule requests - initiator asks
3385  *	for a new scheduling although it already has scheduled FTM slot
3386  * @out_of_window_triggers_num: total FTM triggers out of scheduled window
3387  */
3388 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats {
3389 	u32 filled;
3390 	u32 success_num;
3391 	u32 partial_num;
3392 	u32 failed_num;
3393 	u32 asap_num;
3394 	u32 non_asap_num;
3395 	u64 total_duration_ms;
3396 	u32 unknown_triggers_num;
3397 	u32 reschedule_requests_num;
3398 	u32 out_of_window_triggers_num;
3399 };
3400 
3401 /**
3402  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result - FTM result
3403  * @failure_reason: if this measurement failed (PMSR status is
3404  *	%NL80211_PMSR_STATUS_FAILURE), this gives a more precise
3405  *	reason than just "failure"
3406  * @burst_index: if reporting partial results, this is the index
3407  *	in [0 .. num_bursts-1] of the burst that's being reported
3408  * @num_ftmr_attempts: number of FTM request frames transmitted
3409  * @num_ftmr_successes: number of FTM request frames acked
3410  * @busy_retry_time: if failure_reason is %NL80211_PMSR_FTM_FAILURE_PEER_BUSY,
3411  *	fill this to indicate in how many seconds a retry is deemed possible
3412  *	by the responder
3413  * @num_bursts_exp: actual number of bursts exponent negotiated
3414  * @burst_duration: actual burst duration negotiated
3415  * @ftms_per_burst: actual FTMs per burst negotiated
3416  * @lci_len: length of LCI information (if present)
3417  * @civicloc_len: length of civic location information (if present)
3418  * @lci: LCI data (may be %NULL)
3419  * @civicloc: civic location data (may be %NULL)
3420  * @rssi_avg: average RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3421  * @rssi_spread: spread of the RSSI over FTM action frames reported
3422  * @tx_rate: bitrate for transmitted FTM action frame response
3423  * @rx_rate: bitrate of received FTM action frame
3424  * @rtt_avg: average of RTTs measured (must have either this or @dist_avg)
3425  * @rtt_variance: variance of RTTs measured (note that standard deviation is
3426  *	the square root of the variance)
3427  * @rtt_spread: spread of the RTTs measured
3428  * @dist_avg: average of distances (mm) measured
3429  *	(must have either this or @rtt_avg)
3430  * @dist_variance: variance of distances measured (see also @rtt_variance)
3431  * @dist_spread: spread of distances measured (see also @rtt_spread)
3432  * @num_ftmr_attempts_valid: @num_ftmr_attempts is valid
3433  * @num_ftmr_successes_valid: @num_ftmr_successes is valid
3434  * @rssi_avg_valid: @rssi_avg is valid
3435  * @rssi_spread_valid: @rssi_spread is valid
3436  * @tx_rate_valid: @tx_rate is valid
3437  * @rx_rate_valid: @rx_rate is valid
3438  * @rtt_avg_valid: @rtt_avg is valid
3439  * @rtt_variance_valid: @rtt_variance is valid
3440  * @rtt_spread_valid: @rtt_spread is valid
3441  * @dist_avg_valid: @dist_avg is valid
3442  * @dist_variance_valid: @dist_variance is valid
3443  * @dist_spread_valid: @dist_spread is valid
3444  */
3445 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result {
3446 	const u8 *lci;
3447 	const u8 *civicloc;
3448 	unsigned int lci_len;
3449 	unsigned int civicloc_len;
3450 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_ftm_failure_reasons failure_reason;
3451 	u32 num_ftmr_attempts, num_ftmr_successes;
3452 	s16 burst_index;
3453 	u8 busy_retry_time;
3454 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3455 	u8 burst_duration;
3456 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3457 	s32 rssi_avg;
3458 	s32 rssi_spread;
3459 	struct rate_info tx_rate, rx_rate;
3460 	s64 rtt_avg;
3461 	s64 rtt_variance;
3462 	s64 rtt_spread;
3463 	s64 dist_avg;
3464 	s64 dist_variance;
3465 	s64 dist_spread;
3466 
3467 	u16 num_ftmr_attempts_valid:1,
3468 	    num_ftmr_successes_valid:1,
3469 	    rssi_avg_valid:1,
3470 	    rssi_spread_valid:1,
3471 	    tx_rate_valid:1,
3472 	    rx_rate_valid:1,
3473 	    rtt_avg_valid:1,
3474 	    rtt_variance_valid:1,
3475 	    rtt_spread_valid:1,
3476 	    dist_avg_valid:1,
3477 	    dist_variance_valid:1,
3478 	    dist_spread_valid:1;
3479 };
3480 
3481 /**
3482  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_result - peer measurement result
3483  * @addr: address of the peer
3484  * @host_time: host time (use ktime_get_boottime() adjust to the time when the
3485  *	measurement was made)
3486  * @ap_tsf: AP's TSF at measurement time
3487  * @status: status of the measurement
3488  * @final: if reporting partial results, mark this as the last one; if not
3489  *	reporting partial results always set this flag
3490  * @ap_tsf_valid: indicates the @ap_tsf value is valid
3491  * @type: type of the measurement reported, note that we only support reporting
3492  *	one type at a time, but you can report multiple results separately and
3493  *	they're all aggregated for userspace.
3494  */
3495 struct cfg80211_pmsr_result {
3496 	u64 host_time, ap_tsf;
3497 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_status status;
3498 
3499 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3500 
3501 	u8 final:1,
3502 	   ap_tsf_valid:1;
3503 
3504 	enum nl80211_peer_measurement_type type;
3505 
3506 	union {
3507 		struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_result ftm;
3508 	};
3509 };
3510 
3511 /**
3512  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer - FTM request data
3513  * @requested: indicates FTM is requested
3514  * @preamble: frame preamble to use
3515  * @burst_period: burst period to use
3516  * @asap: indicates to use ASAP mode
3517  * @num_bursts_exp: number of bursts exponent
3518  * @burst_duration: burst duration
3519  * @ftms_per_burst: number of FTMs per burst
3520  * @ftmr_retries: number of retries for FTM request
3521  * @request_lci: request LCI information
3522  * @request_civicloc: request civic location information
3523  * @trigger_based: use trigger based ranging for the measurement
3524  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3525  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3526  * @non_trigger_based: use non trigger based ranging for the measurement
3527  *		 If neither @trigger_based nor @non_trigger_based is set,
3528  *		 EDCA based ranging will be used.
3529  * @lmr_feedback: negotiate for I2R LMR feedback. Only valid if either
3530  *		 @trigger_based or @non_trigger_based is set.
3531  * @bss_color: the bss color of the responder. Optional. Set to zero to
3532  *	indicate the driver should set the BSS color. Only valid if
3533  *	@non_trigger_based or @trigger_based is set.
3534  *
3535  * See also nl80211 for the respective attribute documentation.
3536  */
3537 struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer {
3538 	enum nl80211_preamble preamble;
3539 	u16 burst_period;
3540 	u8 requested:1,
3541 	   asap:1,
3542 	   request_lci:1,
3543 	   request_civicloc:1,
3544 	   trigger_based:1,
3545 	   non_trigger_based:1,
3546 	   lmr_feedback:1;
3547 	u8 num_bursts_exp;
3548 	u8 burst_duration;
3549 	u8 ftms_per_burst;
3550 	u8 ftmr_retries;
3551 	u8 bss_color;
3552 };
3553 
3554 /**
3555  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer - peer data for a peer measurement request
3556  * @addr: MAC address
3557  * @chandef: channel to use
3558  * @report_ap_tsf: report the associated AP's TSF
3559  * @ftm: FTM data, see &struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer
3560  */
3561 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer {
3562 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
3563 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
3564 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1;
3565 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_ftm_request_peer ftm;
3566 };
3567 
3568 /**
3569  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_request - peer measurement request
3570  * @cookie: cookie, set by cfg80211
3571  * @nl_portid: netlink portid - used by cfg80211
3572  * @drv_data: driver data for this request, if required for aborting,
3573  *	not otherwise freed or anything by cfg80211
3574  * @mac_addr: MAC address used for (randomised) request
3575  * @mac_addr_mask: MAC address mask used for randomisation, bits that
3576  *	are 0 in the mask should be randomised, bits that are 1 should
3577  *	be taken from the @mac_addr
3578  * @list: used by cfg80211 to hold on to the request
3579  * @timeout: timeout (in milliseconds) for the whole operation, if
3580  *	zero it means there's no timeout
3581  * @n_peers: number of peers to do measurements with
3582  * @peers: per-peer measurement request data
3583  */
3584 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request {
3585 	u64 cookie;
3586 	void *drv_data;
3587 	u32 n_peers;
3588 	u32 nl_portid;
3589 
3590 	u32 timeout;
3591 
3592 	u8 mac_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3593 	u8 mac_addr_mask[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3594 
3595 	struct list_head list;
3596 
3597 	struct cfg80211_pmsr_request_peer peers[];
3598 };
3599 
3600 /**
3601  * struct cfg80211_update_owe_info - OWE Information
3602  *
3603  * This structure provides information needed for the drivers to offload OWE
3604  * (Opportunistic Wireless Encryption) processing to the user space.
3605  *
3606  * Commonly used across update_owe_info request and event interfaces.
3607  *
3608  * @peer: MAC address of the peer device for which the OWE processing
3609  *	has to be done.
3610  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful OWE info
3611  *	processing, use %WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if user space
3612  *	cannot give you the real status code for failures. Used only for
3613  *	OWE update request command interface (user space to driver).
3614  * @ie: IEs obtained from the peer or constructed by the user space. These are
3615  *	the IEs of the remote peer in the event from the host driver and
3616  *	the constructed IEs by the user space in the request interface.
3617  * @ie_len: Length of IEs in octets.
3618  */
3619 struct cfg80211_update_owe_info {
3620 	u8 peer[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
3621 	u16 status;
3622 	const u8 *ie;
3623 	size_t ie_len;
3624 };
3625 
3626 /**
3627  * struct mgmt_frame_regs - management frame registrations data
3628  * @global_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3629  *	for the entire device
3630  * @interface_stypes: bitmap of management frame subtypes registered
3631  *	for the given interface
3632  * @global_mcast_rx: mcast RX is needed globally for these subtypes
3633  * @interface_mcast_stypes: mcast RX is needed on this interface
3634  *	for these subtypes
3635  */
3636 struct mgmt_frame_regs {
3637 	u32 global_stypes, interface_stypes;
3638 	u32 global_mcast_stypes, interface_mcast_stypes;
3639 };
3640 
3641 /**
3642  * struct cfg80211_ops - backend description for wireless configuration
3643  *
3644  * This struct is registered by fullmac card drivers and/or wireless stacks
3645  * in order to handle configuration requests on their interfaces.
3646  *
3647  * All callbacks except where otherwise noted should return 0
3648  * on success or a negative error code.
3649  *
3650  * All operations are invoked with the wiphy mutex held. The RTNL may be
3651  * held in addition (due to wireless extensions) but this cannot be relied
3652  * upon except in cases where documented below. Note that due to ordering,
3653  * the RTNL also cannot be acquired in any handlers.
3654  *
3655  * @suspend: wiphy device needs to be suspended. The variable @wow will
3656  *	be %NULL or contain the enabled Wake-on-Wireless triggers that are
3657  *	configured for the device.
3658  * @resume: wiphy device needs to be resumed
3659  * @set_wakeup: Called when WoWLAN is enabled/disabled, use this callback
3660  *	to call device_set_wakeup_enable() to enable/disable wakeup from
3661  *	the device.
3662  *
3663  * @add_virtual_intf: create a new virtual interface with the given name,
3664  *	must set the struct wireless_dev's iftype. Beware: You must create
3665  *	the new netdev in the wiphy's network namespace! Returns the struct
3666  *	wireless_dev, or an ERR_PTR. For P2P device wdevs, the driver must
3667  *	also set the address member in the wdev.
3668  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3669  *
3670  * @del_virtual_intf: remove the virtual interface
3671  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3672  *
3673  * @change_virtual_intf: change type/configuration of virtual interface,
3674  *	keep the struct wireless_dev's iftype updated.
3675  *	This additionally holds the RTNL to be able to do netdev changes.
3676  *
3677  * @add_key: add a key with the given parameters. @mac_addr will be %NULL
3678  *	when adding a group key.
3679  *
3680  * @get_key: get information about the key with the given parameters.
3681  *	@mac_addr will be %NULL when requesting information for a group
3682  *	key. All pointers given to the @callback function need not be valid
3683  *	after it returns. This function should return an error if it is
3684  *	not possible to retrieve the key, -ENOENT if it doesn't exist.
3685  *
3686  * @del_key: remove a key given the @mac_addr (%NULL for a group key)
3687  *	and @key_index, return -ENOENT if the key doesn't exist.
3688  *
3689  * @set_default_key: set the default key on an interface
3690  *
3691  * @set_default_mgmt_key: set the default management frame key on an interface
3692  *
3693  * @set_default_beacon_key: set the default Beacon frame key on an interface
3694  *
3695  * @set_rekey_data: give the data necessary for GTK rekeying to the driver
3696  *
3697  * @start_ap: Start acting in AP mode defined by the parameters.
3698  * @change_beacon: Change the beacon parameters for an access point mode
3699  *	interface. This should reject the call when AP mode wasn't started.
3700  * @stop_ap: Stop being an AP, including stopping beaconing.
3701  *
3702  * @add_station: Add a new station.
3703  * @del_station: Remove a station
3704  * @change_station: Modify a given station. Note that flags changes are not much
3705  *	validated in cfg80211, in particular the auth/assoc/authorized flags
3706  *	might come to the driver in invalid combinations -- make sure to check
3707  *	them, also against the existing state! Drivers must call
3708  *	cfg80211_check_station_change() to validate the information.
3709  * @get_station: get station information for the station identified by @mac
3710  * @dump_station: dump station callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3711  *
3712  * @add_mpath: add a fixed mesh path
3713  * @del_mpath: delete a given mesh path
3714  * @change_mpath: change a given mesh path
3715  * @get_mpath: get a mesh path for the given parameters
3716  * @dump_mpath: dump mesh path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3717  * @get_mpp: get a mesh proxy path for the given parameters
3718  * @dump_mpp: dump mesh proxy path callback -- resume dump at index @idx
3719  * @join_mesh: join the mesh network with the specified parameters
3720  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3721  * @leave_mesh: leave the current mesh network
3722  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3723  *
3724  * @get_mesh_config: Get the current mesh configuration
3725  *
3726  * @update_mesh_config: Update mesh parameters on a running mesh.
3727  *	The mask is a bitfield which tells us which parameters to
3728  *	set, and which to leave alone.
3729  *
3730  * @change_bss: Modify parameters for a given BSS.
3731  *
3732  * @set_txq_params: Set TX queue parameters
3733  *
3734  * @libertas_set_mesh_channel: Only for backward compatibility for libertas,
3735  *	as it doesn't implement join_mesh and needs to set the channel to
3736  *	join the mesh instead.
3737  *
3738  * @set_monitor_channel: Set the monitor mode channel for the device. If other
3739  *	interfaces are active this callback should reject the configuration.
3740  *	If no interfaces are active or the device is down, the channel should
3741  *	be stored for when a monitor interface becomes active.
3742  *
3743  * @scan: Request to do a scan. If returning zero, the scan request is given
3744  *	the driver, and will be valid until passed to cfg80211_scan_done().
3745  *	For scan results, call cfg80211_inform_bss(); you can call this outside
3746  *	the scan/scan_done bracket too.
3747  * @abort_scan: Tell the driver to abort an ongoing scan. The driver shall
3748  *	indicate the status of the scan through cfg80211_scan_done().
3749  *
3750  * @auth: Request to authenticate with the specified peer
3751  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3752  * @assoc: Request to (re)associate with the specified peer
3753  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3754  * @deauth: Request to deauthenticate from the specified peer
3755  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3756  * @disassoc: Request to disassociate from the specified peer
3757  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3758  *
3759  * @connect: Connect to the ESS with the specified parameters. When connected,
3760  *	call cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with status code
3761  *	%WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS. If the connection fails for some reason, call
3762  *	cfg80211_connect_result()/cfg80211_connect_bss() with the status code
3763  *	from the AP or cfg80211_connect_timeout() if no frame with status code
3764  *	was received.
3765  *	The driver is allowed to roam to other BSSes within the ESS when the
3766  *	other BSS matches the connect parameters. When such roaming is initiated
3767  *	by the driver, the driver is expected to verify that the target matches
3768  *	the configured security parameters and to use Reassociation Request
3769  *	frame instead of Association Request frame.
3770  *	The connect function can also be used to request the driver to perform a
3771  *	specific roam when connected to an ESS. In that case, the prev_bssid
3772  *	parameter is set to the BSSID of the currently associated BSS as an
3773  *	indication of requesting reassociation.
3774  *	In both the driver-initiated and new connect() call initiated roaming
3775  *	cases, the result of roaming is indicated with a call to
3776  *	cfg80211_roamed(). (invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3777  * @update_connect_params: Update the connect parameters while connected to a
3778  *	BSS. The updated parameters can be used by driver/firmware for
3779  *	subsequent BSS selection (roaming) decisions and to form the
3780  *	Authentication/(Re)Association Request frames. This call does not
3781  *	request an immediate disassociation or reassociation with the current
3782  *	BSS, i.e., this impacts only subsequent (re)associations. The bits in
3783  *	changed are defined in &enum cfg80211_connect_params_changed.
3784  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3785  * @disconnect: Disconnect from the BSS/ESS or stop connection attempts if
3786  *      connection is in progress. Once done, call cfg80211_disconnected() in
3787  *      case connection was already established (invoked with the
3788  *      wireless_dev mutex held), otherwise call cfg80211_connect_timeout().
3789  *
3790  * @join_ibss: Join the specified IBSS (or create if necessary). Once done, call
3791  *	cfg80211_ibss_joined(), also call that function when changing BSSID due
3792  *	to a merge.
3793  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3794  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS.
3795  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3796  *
3797  * @set_mcast_rate: Set the specified multicast rate (only if vif is in ADHOC or
3798  *	MESH mode)
3799  *
3800  * @set_wiphy_params: Notify that wiphy parameters have changed;
3801  *	@changed bitfield (see &enum wiphy_params_flags) describes which values
3802  *	have changed. The actual parameter values are available in
3803  *	struct wiphy. If returning an error, no value should be changed.
3804  *
3805  * @set_tx_power: set the transmit power according to the parameters,
3806  *	the power passed is in mBm, to get dBm use MBM_TO_DBM(). The
3807  *	wdev may be %NULL if power was set for the wiphy, and will
3808  *	always be %NULL unless the driver supports per-vif TX power
3809  *	(as advertised by the nl80211 feature flag.)
3810  * @get_tx_power: store the current TX power into the dbm variable;
3811  *	return 0 if successful
3812  *
3813  * @rfkill_poll: polls the hw rfkill line, use cfg80211 reporting
3814  *	functions to adjust rfkill hw state
3815  *
3816  * @dump_survey: get site survey information.
3817  *
3818  * @remain_on_channel: Request the driver to remain awake on the specified
3819  *	channel for the specified duration to complete an off-channel
3820  *	operation (e.g., public action frame exchange). When the driver is
3821  *	ready on the requested channel, it must indicate this with an event
3822  *	notification by calling cfg80211_ready_on_channel().
3823  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Cancel an on-going remain-on-channel operation.
3824  *	This allows the operation to be terminated prior to timeout based on
3825  *	the duration value.
3826  * @mgmt_tx: Transmit a management frame.
3827  * @mgmt_tx_cancel_wait: Cancel the wait time from transmitting a management
3828  *	frame on another channel
3829  *
3830  * @testmode_cmd: run a test mode command; @wdev may be %NULL
3831  * @testmode_dump: Implement a test mode dump. The cb->args[2] and up may be
3832  *	used by the function, but 0 and 1 must not be touched. Additionally,
3833  *	return error codes other than -ENOBUFS and -ENOENT will terminate the
3834  *	dump and return to userspace with an error, so be careful. If any data
3835  *	was passed in from userspace then the data/len arguments will be present
3836  *	and point to the data contained in %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA.
3837  *
3838  * @set_bitrate_mask: set the bitrate mask configuration
3839  *
3840  * @set_pmksa: Cache a PMKID for a BSSID. This is mostly useful for fullmac
3841  *	devices running firmwares capable of generating the (re) association
3842  *	RSN IE. It allows for faster roaming between WPA2 BSSIDs.
3843  * @del_pmksa: Delete a cached PMKID.
3844  * @flush_pmksa: Flush all cached PMKIDs.
3845  * @set_power_mgmt: Configure WLAN power management. A timeout value of -1
3846  *	allows the driver to adjust the dynamic ps timeout value.
3847  * @set_cqm_rssi_config: Configure connection quality monitor RSSI threshold.
3848  *	After configuration, the driver should (soon) send an event indicating
3849  *	the current level is above/below the configured threshold; this may
3850  *	need some care when the configuration is changed (without first being
3851  *	disabled.)
3852  * @set_cqm_rssi_range_config: Configure two RSSI thresholds in the
3853  *	connection quality monitor.  An event is to be sent only when the
3854  *	signal level is found to be outside the two values.  The driver should
3855  *	set %NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CQM_RSSI_LIST if this method is implemented.
3856  *	If it is provided then there's no point providing @set_cqm_rssi_config.
3857  * @set_cqm_txe_config: Configure connection quality monitor TX error
3858  *	thresholds.
3859  * @sched_scan_start: Tell the driver to start a scheduled scan.
3860  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the driver to stop an ongoing scheduled scan with
3861  *	given request id. This call must stop the scheduled scan and be ready
3862  *	for starting a new one before it returns, i.e. @sched_scan_start may be
3863  *	called immediately after that again and should not fail in that case.
3864  *	The driver should not call cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped() for a requested
3865  *	stop (when this method returns 0).
3866  *
3867  * @update_mgmt_frame_registrations: Notify the driver that management frame
3868  *	registrations were updated. The callback is allowed to sleep.
3869  *
3870  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3871  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3872  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3873  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3874  *
3875  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3876  *
3877  * @tdls_mgmt: Transmit a TDLS management frame.
3878  * @tdls_oper: Perform a high-level TDLS operation (e.g. TDLS link setup).
3879  *
3880  * @probe_client: probe an associated client, must return a cookie that it
3881  *	later passes to cfg80211_probe_status().
3882  *
3883  * @set_noack_map: Set the NoAck Map for the TIDs.
3884  *
3885  * @get_channel: Get the current operating channel for the virtual interface.
3886  *	For monitor interfaces, it should return %NULL unless there's a single
3887  *	current monitoring channel.
3888  *
3889  * @start_p2p_device: Start the given P2P device.
3890  * @stop_p2p_device: Stop the given P2P device.
3891  *
3892  * @set_mac_acl: Sets MAC address control list in AP and P2P GO mode.
3893  *	Parameters include ACL policy, an array of MAC address of stations
3894  *	and the number of MAC addresses. If there is already a list in driver
3895  *	this new list replaces the existing one. Driver has to clear its ACL
3896  *	when number of MAC addresses entries is passed as 0. Drivers which
3897  *	advertise the support for MAC based ACL have to implement this callback.
3898  *
3899  * @start_radar_detection: Start radar detection in the driver.
3900  *
3901  * @end_cac: End running CAC, probably because a related CAC
3902  *	was finished on another phy.
3903  *
3904  * @update_ft_ies: Provide updated Fast BSS Transition information to the
3905  *	driver. If the SME is in the driver/firmware, this information can be
3906  *	used in building Authentication and Reassociation Request frames.
3907  *
3908  * @crit_proto_start: Indicates a critical protocol needs more link reliability
3909  *	for a given duration (milliseconds). The protocol is provided so the
3910  *	driver can take the most appropriate actions.
3911  * @crit_proto_stop: Indicates critical protocol no longer needs increased link
3912  *	reliability. This operation can not fail.
3913  * @set_coalesce: Set coalesce parameters.
3914  *
3915  * @channel_switch: initiate channel-switch procedure (with CSA). Driver is
3916  *	responsible for veryfing if the switch is possible. Since this is
3917  *	inherently tricky driver may decide to disconnect an interface later
3918  *	with cfg80211_stop_iface(). This doesn't mean driver can accept
3919  *	everything. It should do it's best to verify requests and reject them
3920  *	as soon as possible.
3921  *
3922  * @set_qos_map: Set QoS mapping information to the driver
3923  *
3924  * @set_ap_chanwidth: Set the AP (including P2P GO) mode channel width for the
3925  *	given interface This is used e.g. for dynamic HT 20/40 MHz channel width
3926  *	changes during the lifetime of the BSS.
3927  *
3928  * @add_tx_ts: validate (if admitted_time is 0) or add a TX TS to the device
3929  *	with the given parameters; action frame exchange has been handled by
3930  *	userspace so this just has to modify the TX path to take the TS into
3931  *	account.
3932  *	If the admitted time is 0 just validate the parameters to make sure
3933  *	the session can be created at all; it is valid to just always return
3934  *	success for that but that may result in inefficient behaviour (handshake
3935  *	with the peer followed by immediate teardown when the addition is later
3936  *	rejected)
3937  * @del_tx_ts: remove an existing TX TS
3938  *
3939  * @join_ocb: join the OCB network with the specified parameters
3940  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3941  * @leave_ocb: leave the current OCB network
3942  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3943  *
3944  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3945  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3946  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP.
3947  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3948  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3949  * @start_nan: Start the NAN interface.
3950  * @stop_nan: Stop the NAN interface.
3951  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns negative value on failure.
3952  *	On success @nan_func ownership is transferred to the driver and
3953  *	it may access it outside of the scope of this function. The driver
3954  *	should free the @nan_func when no longer needed by calling
3955  *	cfg80211_free_nan_func().
3956  *	On success the driver should assign an instance_id in the
3957  *	provided @nan_func.
3958  * @del_nan_func: Delete a NAN function.
3959  * @nan_change_conf: changes NAN configuration. The changed parameters must
3960  *	be specified in @changes (using &enum cfg80211_nan_conf_changes);
3961  *	All other parameters must be ignored.
3962  *
3963  * @set_multicast_to_unicast: configure multicast to unicast conversion for BSS
3964  *
3965  * @get_txq_stats: Get TXQ stats for interface or phy. If wdev is %NULL, this
3966  *      function should return phy stats, and interface stats otherwise.
3967  *
3968  * @set_pmk: configure the PMK to be used for offloaded 802.1X 4-Way handshake.
3969  *	If not deleted through @del_pmk the PMK remains valid until disconnect
3970  *	upon which the driver should clear it.
3971  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3972  * @del_pmk: delete the previously configured PMK for the given authenticator.
3973  *	(invoked with the wireless_dev mutex held)
3974  *
3975  * @external_auth: indicates result of offloaded authentication processing from
3976  *     user space
3977  *
3978  * @tx_control_port: TX a control port frame (EAPoL).  The noencrypt parameter
3979  *	tells the driver that the frame should not be encrypted.
3980  *
3981  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3982  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3983  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM)
3984  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement
3985  *
3986  * @update_owe_info: Provide updated OWE info to driver. Driver implementing SME
3987  *	but offloading OWE processing to the user space will get the updated
3988  *	DH IE through this interface.
3989  *
3990  * @probe_mesh_link: Probe direct Mesh peer's link quality by sending data frame
3991  *	and overrule HWMP path selection algorithm.
3992  * @set_tid_config: TID specific configuration, this can be peer or BSS specific
3993  *	This callback may sleep.
3994  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer, for the
3995  *	given TIDs. This callback may sleep.
3996  *
3997  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
3998  */
3999 struct cfg80211_ops {
4000 	int	(*suspend)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wow);
4001 	int	(*resume)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4002 	void	(*set_wakeup)(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool enabled);
4003 
4004 	struct wireless_dev * (*add_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4005 						  const char *name,
4006 						  unsigned char name_assign_type,
4007 						  enum nl80211_iftype type,
4008 						  struct vif_params *params);
4009 	int	(*del_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4010 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4011 	int	(*change_virtual_intf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4012 				       struct net_device *dev,
4013 				       enum nl80211_iftype type,
4014 				       struct vif_params *params);
4015 
4016 	int	(*add_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4017 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
4018 			   struct key_params *params);
4019 	int	(*get_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4020 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr,
4021 			   void *cookie,
4022 			   void (*callback)(void *cookie, struct key_params*));
4023 	int	(*del_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4024 			   u8 key_index, bool pairwise, const u8 *mac_addr);
4025 	int	(*set_default_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4026 				   struct net_device *netdev,
4027 				   u8 key_index, bool unicast, bool multicast);
4028 	int	(*set_default_mgmt_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4029 					struct net_device *netdev,
4030 					u8 key_index);
4031 	int	(*set_default_beacon_key)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4032 					  struct net_device *netdev,
4033 					  u8 key_index);
4034 
4035 	int	(*start_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4036 			    struct cfg80211_ap_settings *settings);
4037 	int	(*change_beacon)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4038 				 struct cfg80211_beacon_data *info);
4039 	int	(*stop_ap)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4040 
4041 
4042 	int	(*add_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4043 			       const u8 *mac,
4044 			       struct station_parameters *params);
4045 	int	(*del_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4046 			       struct station_del_parameters *params);
4047 	int	(*change_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4048 				  const u8 *mac,
4049 				  struct station_parameters *params);
4050 	int	(*get_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4051 			       const u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4052 	int	(*dump_station)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4053 				int idx, u8 *mac, struct station_info *sinfo);
4054 
4055 	int	(*add_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4056 			       const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4057 	int	(*del_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4058 			       const u8 *dst);
4059 	int	(*change_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4060 				  const u8 *dst, const u8 *next_hop);
4061 	int	(*get_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4062 			     u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4063 	int	(*dump_mpath)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4064 			      int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *next_hop,
4065 			      struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4066 	int	(*get_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4067 			   u8 *dst, u8 *mpp, struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4068 	int	(*dump_mpp)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4069 			    int idx, u8 *dst, u8 *mpp,
4070 			    struct mpath_info *pinfo);
4071 	int	(*get_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4072 				struct net_device *dev,
4073 				struct mesh_config *conf);
4074 	int	(*update_mesh_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4075 				      struct net_device *dev, u32 mask,
4076 				      const struct mesh_config *nconf);
4077 	int	(*join_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4078 			     const struct mesh_config *conf,
4079 			     const struct mesh_setup *setup);
4080 	int	(*leave_mesh)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4081 
4082 	int	(*join_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4083 			    struct ocb_setup *setup);
4084 	int	(*leave_ocb)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4085 
4086 	int	(*change_bss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4087 			      struct bss_parameters *params);
4088 
4089 	int	(*set_txq_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4090 				  struct ieee80211_txq_params *params);
4091 
4092 	int	(*libertas_set_mesh_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4093 					     struct net_device *dev,
4094 					     struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
4095 
4096 	int	(*set_monitor_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4097 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4098 
4099 	int	(*scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4100 			struct cfg80211_scan_request *request);
4101 	void	(*abort_scan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4102 
4103 	int	(*auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4104 			struct cfg80211_auth_request *req);
4105 	int	(*assoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4106 			 struct cfg80211_assoc_request *req);
4107 	int	(*deauth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4108 			  struct cfg80211_deauth_request *req);
4109 	int	(*disassoc)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4110 			    struct cfg80211_disassoc_request *req);
4111 
4112 	int	(*connect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4113 			   struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme);
4114 	int	(*update_connect_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4115 					 struct net_device *dev,
4116 					 struct cfg80211_connect_params *sme,
4117 					 u32 changed);
4118 	int	(*disconnect)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4119 			      u16 reason_code);
4120 
4121 	int	(*join_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4122 			     struct cfg80211_ibss_params *params);
4123 	int	(*leave_ibss)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev);
4124 
4125 	int	(*set_mcast_rate)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4126 				  int rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS]);
4127 
4128 	int	(*set_wiphy_params)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 changed);
4129 
4130 	int	(*set_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4131 				enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type, int mbm);
4132 	int	(*get_tx_power)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4133 				int *dbm);
4134 
4135 	void	(*rfkill_poll)(struct wiphy *wiphy);
4136 
4137 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4138 	int	(*testmode_cmd)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4139 				void *data, int len);
4140 	int	(*testmode_dump)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct sk_buff *skb,
4141 				 struct netlink_callback *cb,
4142 				 void *data, int len);
4143 #endif
4144 
4145 	int	(*set_bitrate_mask)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4146 				    struct net_device *dev,
4147 				    const u8 *peer,
4148 				    const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4149 
4150 	int	(*dump_survey)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4151 			int idx, struct survey_info *info);
4152 
4153 	int	(*set_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4154 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4155 	int	(*del_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev,
4156 			     struct cfg80211_pmksa *pmksa);
4157 	int	(*flush_pmksa)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *netdev);
4158 
4159 	int	(*remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4160 				     struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4161 				     struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4162 				     unsigned int duration,
4163 				     u64 *cookie);
4164 	int	(*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4165 					    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4166 					    u64 cookie);
4167 
4168 	int	(*mgmt_tx)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4169 			   struct cfg80211_mgmt_tx_params *params,
4170 			   u64 *cookie);
4171 	int	(*mgmt_tx_cancel_wait)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4172 				       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4173 				       u64 cookie);
4174 
4175 	int	(*set_power_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4176 				  bool enabled, int timeout);
4177 
4178 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4179 				       struct net_device *dev,
4180 				       s32 rssi_thold, u32 rssi_hyst);
4181 
4182 	int	(*set_cqm_rssi_range_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4183 					     struct net_device *dev,
4184 					     s32 rssi_low, s32 rssi_high);
4185 
4186 	int	(*set_cqm_txe_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4187 				      struct net_device *dev,
4188 				      u32 rate, u32 pkts, u32 intvl);
4189 
4190 	void	(*update_mgmt_frame_registrations)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4191 						   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4192 						   struct mgmt_frame_regs *upd);
4193 
4194 	int	(*set_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4195 	int	(*get_antenna)(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4196 
4197 	int	(*sched_scan_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4198 				struct net_device *dev,
4199 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *request);
4200 	int	(*sched_scan_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4201 				   u64 reqid);
4202 
4203 	int	(*set_rekey_data)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4204 				  struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4205 
4206 	int	(*tdls_mgmt)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4207 			     const u8 *peer, u8 action_code,  u8 dialog_token,
4208 			     u16 status_code, u32 peer_capability,
4209 			     bool initiator, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4210 	int	(*tdls_oper)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4211 			     const u8 *peer, enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper);
4212 
4213 	int	(*probe_client)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4214 				const u8 *peer, u64 *cookie);
4215 
4216 	int	(*set_noack_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4217 				  struct net_device *dev,
4218 				  u16 noack_map);
4219 
4220 	int	(*get_channel)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4221 			       struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4222 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4223 
4224 	int	(*start_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4225 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4226 	void	(*stop_p2p_device)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4227 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4228 
4229 	int	(*set_mac_acl)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4230 			       const struct cfg80211_acl_data *params);
4231 
4232 	int	(*start_radar_detection)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4233 					 struct net_device *dev,
4234 					 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4235 					 u32 cac_time_ms);
4236 	void	(*end_cac)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4237 				struct net_device *dev);
4238 	int	(*update_ft_ies)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4239 				 struct cfg80211_update_ft_ies_params *ftie);
4240 	int	(*crit_proto_start)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4241 				    struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4242 				    enum nl80211_crit_proto_id protocol,
4243 				    u16 duration);
4244 	void	(*crit_proto_stop)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4245 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4246 	int	(*set_coalesce)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4247 				struct cfg80211_coalesce *coalesce);
4248 
4249 	int	(*channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4250 				  struct net_device *dev,
4251 				  struct cfg80211_csa_settings *params);
4252 
4253 	int     (*set_qos_map)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4254 			       struct net_device *dev,
4255 			       struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
4256 
4257 	int	(*set_ap_chanwidth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4258 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4259 
4260 	int	(*add_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4261 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer, u8 user_prio,
4262 			     u16 admitted_time);
4263 	int	(*del_tx_ts)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4264 			     u8 tsid, const u8 *peer);
4265 
4266 	int	(*tdls_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4267 				       struct net_device *dev,
4268 				       const u8 *addr, u8 oper_class,
4269 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4270 	void	(*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4271 					      struct net_device *dev,
4272 					      const u8 *addr);
4273 	int	(*start_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4274 			     struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4275 	void	(*stop_nan)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev);
4276 	int	(*add_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4277 				struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4278 	void	(*del_nan_func)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4279 			       u64 cookie);
4280 	int	(*nan_change_conf)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4281 				   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4282 				   struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf,
4283 				   u32 changes);
4284 
4285 	int	(*set_multicast_to_unicast)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4286 					    struct net_device *dev,
4287 					    const bool enabled);
4288 
4289 	int	(*get_txq_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4290 				 struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4291 				 struct cfg80211_txq_stats *txqstats);
4292 
4293 	int	(*set_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4294 			   const struct cfg80211_pmk_conf *conf);
4295 	int	(*del_pmk)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4296 			   const u8 *aa);
4297 	int     (*external_auth)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4298 				 struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params);
4299 
4300 	int	(*tx_control_port)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4301 				   struct net_device *dev,
4302 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len,
4303 				   const u8 *dest, const __be16 proto,
4304 				   const bool noencrypt,
4305 				   u64 *cookie);
4306 
4307 	int	(*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4308 				struct net_device *dev,
4309 				struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4310 
4311 	int	(*start_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4312 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4313 	void	(*abort_pmsr)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4314 			      struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4315 	int	(*update_owe_info)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4316 				   struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info);
4317 	int	(*probe_mesh_link)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4318 				   const u8 *buf, size_t len);
4319 	int     (*set_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4320 				  struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4321 	int	(*reset_tid_config)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net_device *dev,
4322 				    const u8 *peer, u8 tids);
4323 	int	(*set_sar_specs)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
4324 				 struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4325 };
4326 
4327 /*
4328  * wireless hardware and networking interfaces structures
4329  * and registration/helper functions
4330  */
4331 
4332 /**
4333  * enum wiphy_flags - wiphy capability flags
4334  *
4335  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ: if set to true, the scan request will be split
4336  *	 into two, first for legacy bands and second for UHB.
4337  * @WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK: if not set, do not allow changing the netns of this
4338  *	wiphy at all
4339  * @WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT: if set to true, powersave will be enabled
4340  *	by default -- this flag will be set depending on the kernel's default
4341  *	on wiphy_new(), but can be changed by the driver if it has a good
4342  *	reason to override the default
4343  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP: supports 4addr mode even on AP (with a single station
4344  *	on a VLAN interface). This flag also serves an extra purpose of
4345  *	supporting 4ADDR AP mode on devices which do not support AP/VLAN iftype.
4346  * @WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION: supports 4addr mode even as a station
4347  * @WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL: This device supports setting the
4348  *	control port protocol ethertype. The device also honours the
4349  *	control_port_no_encrypt flag.
4350  * @WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN: The device supports IBSS RSN.
4351  * @WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH: The device supports mesh authentication by routing
4352  *	auth frames to userspace. See @NL80211_MESH_SETUP_USERSPACE_AUTH.
4353  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM: The device supports roaming feature in the
4354  *	firmware.
4355  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD: The device supports uapsd on AP.
4356  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS: The device supports TDLS (802.11z) operation.
4357  * @WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP: The device does not handle TDLS (802.11z)
4358  *	link setup/discovery operations internally. Setup, discovery and
4359  *	teardown packets should be sent through the @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_MGMT
4360  *	command. When this flag is not set, @NL80211_CMD_TDLS_OPER should be
4361  *	used for asking the driver/firmware to perform a TDLS operation.
4362  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME: device integrates AP SME
4363  * @WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS: the device will report beacons from other BSSes
4364  *	when there are virtual interfaces in AP mode by calling
4365  *	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon().
4366  * @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD: When operating as an AP, the device
4367  *	responds to probe-requests in hardware.
4368  * @WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX: Device supports direct off-channel TX.
4369  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL: Device supports remain-on-channel call.
4370  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ: Device supports 5 MHz and 10 MHz channels.
4371  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH: Device supports channel switch in
4372  *	beaconing mode (AP, IBSS, Mesh, ...).
4373  * @WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP: The device supports static WEP key installation
4374  *	before connection.
4375  * @WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK: The device supports bigger kek and kck keys
4376  */
4377 enum wiphy_flags {
4378 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_EXT_KEK_KCK		= BIT(0),
4379 	/* use hole at 1 */
4380 	WIPHY_FLAG_SPLIT_SCAN_6GHZ		= BIT(2),
4381 	WIPHY_FLAG_NETNS_OK			= BIT(3),
4382 	WIPHY_FLAG_PS_ON_BY_DEFAULT		= BIT(4),
4383 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_AP			= BIT(5),
4384 	WIPHY_FLAG_4ADDR_STATION		= BIT(6),
4385 	WIPHY_FLAG_CONTROL_PORT_PROTOCOL	= BIT(7),
4386 	WIPHY_FLAG_IBSS_RSN			= BIT(8),
4387 	WIPHY_FLAG_MESH_AUTH			= BIT(10),
4388 	/* use hole at 11 */
4389 	/* use hole at 12 */
4390 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_FW_ROAM		= BIT(13),
4391 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_UAPSD			= BIT(14),
4392 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_TDLS		= BIT(15),
4393 	WIPHY_FLAG_TDLS_EXTERNAL_SETUP		= BIT(16),
4394 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAVE_AP_SME			= BIT(17),
4395 	WIPHY_FLAG_REPORTS_OBSS			= BIT(18),
4396 	WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD	= BIT(19),
4397 	WIPHY_FLAG_OFFCHAN_TX			= BIT(20),
4398 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_REMAIN_ON_CHANNEL	= BIT(21),
4399 	WIPHY_FLAG_SUPPORTS_5_10_MHZ		= BIT(22),
4400 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_CHANNEL_SWITCH		= BIT(23),
4401 	WIPHY_FLAG_HAS_STATIC_WEP		= BIT(24),
4402 };
4403 
4404 /**
4405  * struct ieee80211_iface_limit - limit on certain interface types
4406  * @max: maximum number of interfaces of these types
4407  * @types: interface types (bits)
4408  */
4409 struct ieee80211_iface_limit {
4410 	u16 max;
4411 	u16 types;
4412 };
4413 
4414 /**
4415  * struct ieee80211_iface_combination - possible interface combination
4416  *
4417  * With this structure the driver can describe which interface
4418  * combinations it supports concurrently.
4419  *
4420  * Examples:
4421  *
4422  * 1. Allow #STA <= 1, #AP <= 1, matching BI, channels = 1, 2 total:
4423  *
4424  *    .. code-block:: c
4425  *
4426  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits1[] = {
4427  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4428  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP}, },
4429  *	};
4430  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination1 = {
4431  *		.limits = limits1,
4432  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits1),
4433  *		.max_interfaces = 2,
4434  *		.beacon_int_infra_match = true,
4435  *	};
4436  *
4437  *
4438  * 2. Allow #{AP, P2P-GO} <= 8, channels = 1, 8 total:
4439  *
4440  *    .. code-block:: c
4441  *
4442  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits2[] = {
4443  *		{ .max = 8, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_AP) |
4444  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO), },
4445  *	};
4446  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination2 = {
4447  *		.limits = limits2,
4448  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits2),
4449  *		.max_interfaces = 8,
4450  *		.num_different_channels = 1,
4451  *	};
4452  *
4453  *
4454  * 3. Allow #STA <= 1, #{P2P-client,P2P-GO} <= 3 on two channels, 4 total.
4455  *
4456  *    This allows for an infrastructure connection and three P2P connections.
4457  *
4458  *    .. code-block:: c
4459  *
4460  *	struct ieee80211_iface_limit limits3[] = {
4461  *		{ .max = 1, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION), },
4462  *		{ .max = 3, .types = BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO) |
4463  *				     BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT), },
4464  *	};
4465  *	struct ieee80211_iface_combination combination3 = {
4466  *		.limits = limits3,
4467  *		.n_limits = ARRAY_SIZE(limits3),
4468  *		.max_interfaces = 4,
4469  *		.num_different_channels = 2,
4470  *	};
4471  *
4472  */
4473 struct ieee80211_iface_combination {
4474 	/**
4475 	 * @limits:
4476 	 * limits for the given interface types
4477 	 */
4478 	const struct ieee80211_iface_limit *limits;
4479 
4480 	/**
4481 	 * @num_different_channels:
4482 	 * can use up to this many different channels
4483 	 */
4484 	u32 num_different_channels;
4485 
4486 	/**
4487 	 * @max_interfaces:
4488 	 * maximum number of interfaces in total allowed in this group
4489 	 */
4490 	u16 max_interfaces;
4491 
4492 	/**
4493 	 * @n_limits:
4494 	 * number of limitations
4495 	 */
4496 	u8 n_limits;
4497 
4498 	/**
4499 	 * @beacon_int_infra_match:
4500 	 * In this combination, the beacon intervals between infrastructure
4501 	 * and AP types must match. This is required only in special cases.
4502 	 */
4503 	bool beacon_int_infra_match;
4504 
4505 	/**
4506 	 * @radar_detect_widths:
4507 	 * bitmap of channel widths supported for radar detection
4508 	 */
4509 	u8 radar_detect_widths;
4510 
4511 	/**
4512 	 * @radar_detect_regions:
4513 	 * bitmap of regions supported for radar detection
4514 	 */
4515 	u8 radar_detect_regions;
4516 
4517 	/**
4518 	 * @beacon_int_min_gcd:
4519 	 * This interface combination supports different beacon intervals.
4520 	 *
4521 	 * = 0
4522 	 *   all beacon intervals for different interface must be same.
4523 	 * > 0
4524 	 *   any beacon interval for the interface part of this combination AND
4525 	 *   GCD of all beacon intervals from beaconing interfaces of this
4526 	 *   combination must be greater or equal to this value.
4527 	 */
4528 	u32 beacon_int_min_gcd;
4529 };
4530 
4531 struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes {
4532 	u16 tx, rx;
4533 };
4534 
4535 /**
4536  * enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags - WoWLAN support flags
4537  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY: supports wakeup for the special "any"
4538  *	trigger that keeps the device operating as-is and
4539  *	wakes up the host on any activity, for example a
4540  *	received packet that passed filtering; note that the
4541  *	packet should be preserved in that case
4542  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT: supports wakeup on magic packet
4543  *	(see nl80211.h)
4544  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT: supports wakeup on disconnect
4545  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY: supports GTK rekeying while asleep
4546  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE: supports wakeup on GTK rekey failure
4547  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ: supports wakeup on EAP identity request
4548  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE: supports wakeup on 4-way handshake failure
4549  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE: supports wakeup on RF-kill release
4550  * @WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT: supports wakeup on network detection
4551  */
4552 enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags {
4553 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_ANY		= BIT(0),
4554 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_MAGIC_PKT		= BIT(1),
4555 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_DISCONNECT		= BIT(2),
4556 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_SUPPORTS_GTK_REKEY	= BIT(3),
4557 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_GTK_REKEY_FAILURE	= BIT(4),
4558 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_EAP_IDENTITY_REQ	= BIT(5),
4559 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_4WAY_HANDSHAKE	= BIT(6),
4560 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_RFKILL_RELEASE	= BIT(7),
4561 	WIPHY_WOWLAN_NET_DETECT		= BIT(8),
4562 };
4563 
4564 struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support {
4565 	const struct nl80211_wowlan_tcp_data_token_feature *tok;
4566 	u32 data_payload_max;
4567 	u32 data_interval_max;
4568 	u32 wake_payload_max;
4569 	bool seq;
4570 };
4571 
4572 /**
4573  * struct wiphy_wowlan_support - WoWLAN support data
4574  * @flags: see &enum wiphy_wowlan_support_flags
4575  * @n_patterns: number of supported wakeup patterns
4576  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4577  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4578  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4579  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4580  * @max_nd_match_sets: maximum number of matchsets for net-detect,
4581  *	similar, but not necessarily identical, to max_match_sets for
4582  *	scheduled scans.
4583  *	See &struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request.@match_sets for more
4584  *	details.
4585  * @tcp: TCP wakeup support information
4586  */
4587 struct wiphy_wowlan_support {
4588 	u32 flags;
4589 	int n_patterns;
4590 	int pattern_max_len;
4591 	int pattern_min_len;
4592 	int max_pkt_offset;
4593 	int max_nd_match_sets;
4594 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_tcp_support *tcp;
4595 };
4596 
4597 /**
4598  * struct wiphy_coalesce_support - coalesce support data
4599  * @n_rules: maximum number of coalesce rules
4600  * @max_delay: maximum supported coalescing delay in msecs
4601  * @n_patterns: number of supported patterns in a rule
4602  *	(see nl80211.h for the pattern definition)
4603  * @pattern_max_len: maximum length of each pattern
4604  * @pattern_min_len: minimum length of each pattern
4605  * @max_pkt_offset: maximum Rx packet offset
4606  */
4607 struct wiphy_coalesce_support {
4608 	int n_rules;
4609 	int max_delay;
4610 	int n_patterns;
4611 	int pattern_max_len;
4612 	int pattern_min_len;
4613 	int max_pkt_offset;
4614 };
4615 
4616 /**
4617  * enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags - validation flags for vendor commands
4618  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV: vendor command requires wdev
4619  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV: vendor command requires netdev
4620  * @WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING: interface/wdev must be up & running
4621  *	(must be combined with %_WDEV or %_NETDEV)
4622  */
4623 enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags {
4624 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_WDEV = BIT(0),
4625 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_NETDEV = BIT(1),
4626 	WIPHY_VENDOR_CMD_NEED_RUNNING = BIT(2),
4627 };
4628 
4629 /**
4630  * enum wiphy_opmode_flag - Station's ht/vht operation mode information flags
4631  *
4632  * @STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED: Max Bandwidth changed
4633  * @STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED: SMPS mode changed
4634  * @STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED: max N_SS (number of spatial streams) changed
4635  *
4636  */
4637 enum wiphy_opmode_flag {
4638 	STA_OPMODE_MAX_BW_CHANGED	= BIT(0),
4639 	STA_OPMODE_SMPS_MODE_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
4640 	STA_OPMODE_N_SS_CHANGED		= BIT(2),
4641 };
4642 
4643 /**
4644  * struct sta_opmode_info - Station's ht/vht operation mode information
4645  * @changed: contains value from &enum wiphy_opmode_flag
4646  * @smps_mode: New SMPS mode value from &enum nl80211_smps_mode of a station
4647  * @bw: new max bandwidth value from &enum nl80211_chan_width of a station
4648  * @rx_nss: new rx_nss value of a station
4649  */
4650 
4651 struct sta_opmode_info {
4652 	u32 changed;
4653 	enum nl80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
4654 	enum nl80211_chan_width bw;
4655 	u8 rx_nss;
4656 };
4657 
4658 #define VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA ((const struct nla_policy *)(long)(-ENODATA))
4659 
4660 /**
4661  * struct wiphy_vendor_command - vendor command definition
4662  * @info: vendor command identifying information, as used in nl80211
4663  * @flags: flags, see &enum wiphy_vendor_command_flags
4664  * @doit: callback for the operation, note that wdev is %NULL if the
4665  *	flags didn't ask for a wdev and non-%NULL otherwise; the data
4666  *	pointer may be %NULL if userspace provided no data at all
4667  * @dumpit: dump callback, for transferring bigger/multiple items. The
4668  *	@storage points to cb->args[5], ie. is preserved over the multiple
4669  *	dumpit calls.
4670  * @policy: policy pointer for attributes within %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA.
4671  *	Set this to %VENDOR_CMD_RAW_DATA if no policy can be given and the
4672  *	attribute is just raw data (e.g. a firmware command).
4673  * @maxattr: highest attribute number in policy
4674  * It's recommended to not have the same sub command with both @doit and
4675  * @dumpit, so that userspace can assume certain ones are get and others
4676  * are used with dump requests.
4677  */
4678 struct wiphy_vendor_command {
4679 	struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info info;
4680 	u32 flags;
4681 	int (*doit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4682 		    const void *data, int data_len);
4683 	int (*dumpit)(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
4684 		      struct sk_buff *skb, const void *data, int data_len,
4685 		      unsigned long *storage);
4686 	const struct nla_policy *policy;
4687 	unsigned int maxattr;
4688 };
4689 
4690 /**
4691  * struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab - extended capabilities per interface type
4692  * @iftype: interface type
4693  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4694  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are the
4695  *	802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element") and are
4696  *	in the same format as in the information element. See IEEE Std
4697  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields.
4698  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4699  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4700  */
4701 struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab {
4702 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
4703 	const u8 *extended_capabilities;
4704 	const u8 *extended_capabilities_mask;
4705 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
4706 };
4707 
4708 /**
4709  * struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities - cfg80211 peer measurement capabilities
4710  * @max_peers: maximum number of peers in a single measurement
4711  * @report_ap_tsf: can report assoc AP's TSF for radio resource measurement
4712  * @randomize_mac_addr: can randomize MAC address for measurement
4713  * @ftm.supported: FTM measurement is supported
4714  * @ftm.asap: ASAP-mode is supported
4715  * @ftm.non_asap: non-ASAP-mode is supported
4716  * @ftm.request_lci: can request LCI data
4717  * @ftm.request_civicloc: can request civic location data
4718  * @ftm.preambles: bitmap of preambles supported (&enum nl80211_preamble)
4719  * @ftm.bandwidths: bitmap of bandwidths supported (&enum nl80211_chan_width)
4720  * @ftm.max_bursts_exponent: maximum burst exponent supported
4721  *	(set to -1 if not limited; note that setting this will necessarily
4722  *	forbid using the value 15 to let the responder pick)
4723  * @ftm.max_ftms_per_burst: maximum FTMs per burst supported (set to 0 if
4724  *	not limited)
4725  * @ftm.trigger_based: trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4726  * @ftm.non_trigger_based: non trigger based ranging measurement is supported
4727  */
4728 struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities {
4729 	unsigned int max_peers;
4730 	u8 report_ap_tsf:1,
4731 	   randomize_mac_addr:1;
4732 
4733 	struct {
4734 		u32 preambles;
4735 		u32 bandwidths;
4736 		s8 max_bursts_exponent;
4737 		u8 max_ftms_per_burst;
4738 		u8 supported:1,
4739 		   asap:1,
4740 		   non_asap:1,
4741 		   request_lci:1,
4742 		   request_civicloc:1,
4743 		   trigger_based:1,
4744 		   non_trigger_based:1;
4745 	} ftm;
4746 };
4747 
4748 /**
4749  * struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites - This structure encapsulates supported akm
4750  * suites for interface types defined in @iftypes_mask. Each type in the
4751  * @iftypes_mask must be unique across all instances of iftype_akm_suites.
4752  *
4753  * @iftypes_mask: bitmask of interfaces types
4754  * @akm_suites: points to an array of supported akm suites
4755  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4756  */
4757 struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites {
4758 	u16 iftypes_mask;
4759 	const u32 *akm_suites;
4760 	int n_akm_suites;
4761 };
4762 
4763 /**
4764  * struct wiphy - wireless hardware description
4765  * @mtx: mutex for the data (structures) of this device
4766  * @reg_notifier: the driver's regulatory notification callback,
4767  *	note that if your driver uses wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory()
4768  *	the reg_notifier's request can be passed as NULL
4769  * @regd: the driver's regulatory domain, if one was requested via
4770  *	the regulatory_hint() API. This can be used by the driver
4771  *	on the reg_notifier() if it chooses to ignore future
4772  *	regulatory domain changes caused by other drivers.
4773  * @signal_type: signal type reported in &struct cfg80211_bss.
4774  * @cipher_suites: supported cipher suites
4775  * @n_cipher_suites: number of supported cipher suites
4776  * @akm_suites: supported AKM suites. These are the default AKMs supported if
4777  *	the supported AKMs not advertized for a specific interface type in
4778  *	iftype_akm_suites.
4779  * @n_akm_suites: number of supported AKM suites
4780  * @iftype_akm_suites: array of supported akm suites info per interface type.
4781  *	Note that the bits in @iftypes_mask inside this structure cannot
4782  *	overlap (i.e. only one occurrence of each type is allowed across all
4783  *	instances of iftype_akm_suites).
4784  * @num_iftype_akm_suites: number of interface types for which supported akm
4785  *	suites are specified separately.
4786  * @retry_short: Retry limit for short frames (dot11ShortRetryLimit)
4787  * @retry_long: Retry limit for long frames (dot11LongRetryLimit)
4788  * @frag_threshold: Fragmentation threshold (dot11FragmentationThreshold);
4789  *	-1 = fragmentation disabled, only odd values >= 256 used
4790  * @rts_threshold: RTS threshold (dot11RTSThreshold); -1 = RTS/CTS disabled
4791  * @_net: the network namespace this wiphy currently lives in
4792  * @perm_addr: permanent MAC address of this device
4793  * @addr_mask: If the device supports multiple MAC addresses by masking,
4794  *	set this to a mask with variable bits set to 1, e.g. if the last
4795  *	four bits are variable then set it to 00-00-00-00-00-0f. The actual
4796  *	variable bits shall be determined by the interfaces added, with
4797  *	interfaces not matching the mask being rejected to be brought up.
4798  * @n_addresses: number of addresses in @addresses.
4799  * @addresses: If the device has more than one address, set this pointer
4800  *	to a list of addresses (6 bytes each). The first one will be used
4801  *	by default for perm_addr. In this case, the mask should be set to
4802  *	all-zeroes. In this case it is assumed that the device can handle
4803  *	the same number of arbitrary MAC addresses.
4804  * @registered: protects ->resume and ->suspend sysfs callbacks against
4805  *	unregister hardware
4806  * @debugfsdir: debugfs directory used for this wiphy (ieee80211/<wiphyname>).
4807  *	It will be renamed automatically on wiphy renames
4808  * @dev: (virtual) struct device for this wiphy. The item in
4809  *	/sys/class/ieee80211/ points to this. You need use set_wiphy_dev()
4810  *	(see below).
4811  * @wext: wireless extension handlers
4812  * @priv: driver private data (sized according to wiphy_new() parameter)
4813  * @interface_modes: bitmask of interfaces types valid for this wiphy,
4814  *	must be set by driver
4815  * @iface_combinations: Valid interface combinations array, should not
4816  *	list single interface types.
4817  * @n_iface_combinations: number of entries in @iface_combinations array.
4818  * @software_iftypes: bitmask of software interface types, these are not
4819  *	subject to any restrictions since they are purely managed in SW.
4820  * @flags: wiphy flags, see &enum wiphy_flags
4821  * @regulatory_flags: wiphy regulatory flags, see
4822  *	&enum ieee80211_regulatory_flags
4823  * @features: features advertised to nl80211, see &enum nl80211_feature_flags.
4824  * @ext_features: extended features advertised to nl80211, see
4825  *	&enum nl80211_ext_feature_index.
4826  * @bss_priv_size: each BSS struct has private data allocated with it,
4827  *	this variable determines its size
4828  * @max_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan for in
4829  *	any given scan
4830  * @max_sched_scan_reqs: maximum number of scheduled scan requests that
4831  *	the device can run concurrently.
4832  * @max_sched_scan_ssids: maximum number of SSIDs the device can scan
4833  *	for in any given scheduled scan
4834  * @max_match_sets: maximum number of match sets the device can handle
4835  *	when performing a scheduled scan, 0 if filtering is not
4836  *	supported.
4837  * @max_scan_ie_len: maximum length of user-controlled IEs device can
4838  *	add to probe request frames transmitted during a scan, must not
4839  *	include fixed IEs like supported rates
4840  * @max_sched_scan_ie_len: same as max_scan_ie_len, but for scheduled
4841  *	scans
4842  * @max_sched_scan_plans: maximum number of scan plans (scan interval and number
4843  *	of iterations) for scheduled scan supported by the device.
4844  * @max_sched_scan_plan_interval: maximum interval (in seconds) for a
4845  *	single scan plan supported by the device.
4846  * @max_sched_scan_plan_iterations: maximum number of iterations for a single
4847  *	scan plan supported by the device.
4848  * @coverage_class: current coverage class
4849  * @fw_version: firmware version for ethtool reporting
4850  * @hw_version: hardware version for ethtool reporting
4851  * @max_num_pmkids: maximum number of PMKIDs supported by device
4852  * @privid: a pointer that drivers can use to identify if an arbitrary
4853  *	wiphy is theirs, e.g. in global notifiers
4854  * @bands: information about bands/channels supported by this device
4855  *
4856  * @mgmt_stypes: bitmasks of frame subtypes that can be subscribed to or
4857  *	transmitted through nl80211, points to an array indexed by interface
4858  *	type
4859  *
4860  * @available_antennas_tx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4861  *	configured as TX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4862  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_rx is set.
4863  *
4864  * @available_antennas_rx: bitmap of antennas which are available to be
4865  *	configured as RX antennas. Antenna configuration commands will be
4866  *	rejected unless this or @available_antennas_tx is set.
4867  *
4868  * @probe_resp_offload:
4869  *	 Bitmap of supported protocols for probe response offloading.
4870  *	 See &enum nl80211_probe_resp_offload_support_attr. Only valid
4871  *	 when the wiphy flag @WIPHY_FLAG_AP_PROBE_RESP_OFFLOAD is set.
4872  *
4873  * @max_remain_on_channel_duration: Maximum time a remain-on-channel operation
4874  *	may request, if implemented.
4875  *
4876  * @wowlan: WoWLAN support information
4877  * @wowlan_config: current WoWLAN configuration; this should usually not be
4878  *	used since access to it is necessarily racy, use the parameter passed
4879  *	to the suspend() operation instead.
4880  *
4881  * @ap_sme_capa: AP SME capabilities, flags from &enum nl80211_ap_sme_features.
4882  * @ht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what ht_cap values can be over-ridden.
4883  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4884  * @vht_capa_mod_mask:  Specify what VHT capabilities can be over-ridden.
4885  *	If null, then none can be over-ridden.
4886  *
4887  * @wdev_list: the list of associated (virtual) interfaces; this list must
4888  *	not be modified by the driver, but can be read with RTNL/RCU protection.
4889  *
4890  * @max_acl_mac_addrs: Maximum number of MAC addresses that the device
4891  *	supports for ACL.
4892  *
4893  * @extended_capabilities: extended capabilities supported by the driver,
4894  *	additional capabilities might be supported by userspace; these are
4895  *	the 802.11 extended capabilities ("Extended Capabilities element")
4896  *	and are in the same format as in the information element. See
4897  *	802.11-2012 8.4.2.29 for the defined fields. These are the default
4898  *	extended capabilities to be used if the capabilities are not specified
4899  *	for a specific interface type in iftype_ext_capab.
4900  * @extended_capabilities_mask: mask of the valid values
4901  * @extended_capabilities_len: length of the extended capabilities
4902  * @iftype_ext_capab: array of extended capabilities per interface type
4903  * @num_iftype_ext_capab: number of interface types for which extended
4904  *	capabilities are specified separately.
4905  * @coalesce: packet coalescing support information
4906  *
4907  * @vendor_commands: array of vendor commands supported by the hardware
4908  * @n_vendor_commands: number of vendor commands
4909  * @vendor_events: array of vendor events supported by the hardware
4910  * @n_vendor_events: number of vendor events
4911  *
4912  * @max_ap_assoc_sta: maximum number of associated stations supported in AP mode
4913  *	(including P2P GO) or 0 to indicate no such limit is advertised. The
4914  *	driver is allowed to advertise a theoretical limit that it can reach in
4915  *	some cases, but may not always reach.
4916  *
4917  * @max_num_csa_counters: Number of supported csa_counters in beacons
4918  *	and probe responses.  This value should be set if the driver
4919  *	wishes to limit the number of csa counters. Default (0) means
4920  *	infinite.
4921  * @bss_select_support: bitmask indicating the BSS selection criteria supported
4922  *	by the driver in the .connect() callback. The bit position maps to the
4923  *	attribute indices defined in &enum nl80211_bss_select_attr.
4924  *
4925  * @nan_supported_bands: bands supported by the device in NAN mode, a
4926  *	bitmap of &enum nl80211_band values.  For instance, for
4927  *	NL80211_BAND_2GHZ, bit 0 would be set
4928  *	(i.e. BIT(NL80211_BAND_2GHZ)).
4929  *
4930  * @txq_limit: configuration of internal TX queue frame limit
4931  * @txq_memory_limit: configuration internal TX queue memory limit
4932  * @txq_quantum: configuration of internal TX queue scheduler quantum
4933  *
4934  * @tx_queue_len: allow setting transmit queue len for drivers not using
4935  *	wake_tx_queue
4936  *
4937  * @support_mbssid: can HW support association with nontransmitted AP
4938  * @support_only_he_mbssid: don't parse MBSSID elements if it is not
4939  *	HE AP, in order to avoid compatibility issues.
4940  *	@support_mbssid must be set for this to have any effect.
4941  *
4942  * @pmsr_capa: peer measurement capabilities
4943  *
4944  * @tid_config_support: describes the per-TID config support that the
4945  *	device has
4946  * @tid_config_support.vif: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4947  *	supported by the driver for each vif
4948  * @tid_config_support.peer: bitmap of attributes (configurations)
4949  *	supported by the driver for each peer
4950  * @tid_config_support.max_retry: maximum supported retry count for
4951  *	long/short retry configuration
4952  *
4953  * @max_data_retry_count: maximum supported per TID retry count for
4954  *	configuration through the %NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_SHORT and
4955  *	%NL80211_TID_CONFIG_ATTR_RETRY_LONG attributes
4956  * @sar_capa: SAR control capabilities
4957  * @rfkill: a pointer to the rfkill structure
4958  */
4959 struct wiphy {
4960 	struct mutex mtx;
4961 
4962 	/* assign these fields before you register the wiphy */
4963 
4964 	u8 perm_addr[ETH_ALEN];
4965 	u8 addr_mask[ETH_ALEN];
4966 
4967 	struct mac_address *addresses;
4968 
4969 	const struct ieee80211_txrx_stypes *mgmt_stypes;
4970 
4971 	const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *iface_combinations;
4972 	int n_iface_combinations;
4973 	u16 software_iftypes;
4974 
4975 	u16 n_addresses;
4976 
4977 	/* Supported interface modes, OR together BIT(NL80211_IFTYPE_...) */
4978 	u16 interface_modes;
4979 
4980 	u16 max_acl_mac_addrs;
4981 
4982 	u32 flags, regulatory_flags, features;
4983 	u8 ext_features[DIV_ROUND_UP(NUM_NL80211_EXT_FEATURES, 8)];
4984 
4985 	u32 ap_sme_capa;
4986 
4987 	enum cfg80211_signal_type signal_type;
4988 
4989 	int bss_priv_size;
4990 	u8 max_scan_ssids;
4991 	u8 max_sched_scan_reqs;
4992 	u8 max_sched_scan_ssids;
4993 	u8 max_match_sets;
4994 	u16 max_scan_ie_len;
4995 	u16 max_sched_scan_ie_len;
4996 	u32 max_sched_scan_plans;
4997 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_interval;
4998 	u32 max_sched_scan_plan_iterations;
4999 
5000 	int n_cipher_suites;
5001 	const u32 *cipher_suites;
5002 
5003 	int n_akm_suites;
5004 	const u32 *akm_suites;
5005 
5006 	const struct wiphy_iftype_akm_suites *iftype_akm_suites;
5007 	unsigned int num_iftype_akm_suites;
5008 
5009 	u8 retry_short;
5010 	u8 retry_long;
5011 	u32 frag_threshold;
5012 	u32 rts_threshold;
5013 	u8 coverage_class;
5014 
5015 	char fw_version[ETHTOOL_FWVERS_LEN];
5016 	u32 hw_version;
5017 
5018 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
5019 	const struct wiphy_wowlan_support *wowlan;
5020 	struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan_config;
5021 #endif
5022 
5023 	u16 max_remain_on_channel_duration;
5024 
5025 	u8 max_num_pmkids;
5026 
5027 	u32 available_antennas_tx;
5028 	u32 available_antennas_rx;
5029 
5030 	u32 probe_resp_offload;
5031 
5032 	const u8 *extended_capabilities, *extended_capabilities_mask;
5033 	u8 extended_capabilities_len;
5034 
5035 	const struct wiphy_iftype_ext_capab *iftype_ext_capab;
5036 	unsigned int num_iftype_ext_capab;
5037 
5038 	const void *privid;
5039 
5040 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *bands[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
5041 
5042 	void (*reg_notifier)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
5043 			     struct regulatory_request *request);
5044 
5045 	/* fields below are read-only, assigned by cfg80211 */
5046 
5047 	const struct ieee80211_regdomain __rcu *regd;
5048 
5049 	struct device dev;
5050 
5051 	bool registered;
5052 
5053 	struct dentry *debugfsdir;
5054 
5055 	const struct ieee80211_ht_cap *ht_capa_mod_mask;
5056 	const struct ieee80211_vht_cap *vht_capa_mod_mask;
5057 
5058 	struct list_head wdev_list;
5059 
5060 	possible_net_t _net;
5061 
5062 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5063 	const struct iw_handler_def *wext;
5064 #endif
5065 
5066 	const struct wiphy_coalesce_support *coalesce;
5067 
5068 	const struct wiphy_vendor_command *vendor_commands;
5069 	const struct nl80211_vendor_cmd_info *vendor_events;
5070 	int n_vendor_commands, n_vendor_events;
5071 
5072 	u16 max_ap_assoc_sta;
5073 
5074 	u8 max_num_csa_counters;
5075 
5076 	u32 bss_select_support;
5077 
5078 	u8 nan_supported_bands;
5079 
5080 	u32 txq_limit;
5081 	u32 txq_memory_limit;
5082 	u32 txq_quantum;
5083 
5084 	unsigned long tx_queue_len;
5085 
5086 	u8 support_mbssid:1,
5087 	   support_only_he_mbssid:1;
5088 
5089 	const struct cfg80211_pmsr_capabilities *pmsr_capa;
5090 
5091 	struct {
5092 		u64 peer, vif;
5093 		u8 max_retry;
5094 	} tid_config_support;
5095 
5096 	u8 max_data_retry_count;
5097 
5098 	const struct cfg80211_sar_capa *sar_capa;
5099 
5100 	struct rfkill *rfkill;
5101 
5102 	char priv[] __aligned(NETDEV_ALIGN);
5103 };
5104 
5105 static inline struct net *wiphy_net(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5106 {
5107 	return read_pnet(&wiphy->_net);
5108 }
5109 
5110 static inline void wiphy_net_set(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct net *net)
5111 {
5112 	write_pnet(&wiphy->_net, net);
5113 }
5114 
5115 /**
5116  * wiphy_priv - return priv from wiphy
5117  *
5118  * @wiphy: the wiphy whose priv pointer to return
5119  * Return: The priv of @wiphy.
5120  */
5121 static inline void *wiphy_priv(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5122 {
5123 	BUG_ON(!wiphy);
5124 	return &wiphy->priv;
5125 }
5126 
5127 /**
5128  * priv_to_wiphy - return the wiphy containing the priv
5129  *
5130  * @priv: a pointer previously returned by wiphy_priv
5131  * Return: The wiphy of @priv.
5132  */
5133 static inline struct wiphy *priv_to_wiphy(void *priv)
5134 {
5135 	BUG_ON(!priv);
5136 	return container_of(priv, struct wiphy, priv);
5137 }
5138 
5139 /**
5140  * set_wiphy_dev - set device pointer for wiphy
5141  *
5142  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device to bind
5143  * @dev: The device to parent it to
5144  */
5145 static inline void set_wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct device *dev)
5146 {
5147 	wiphy->dev.parent = dev;
5148 }
5149 
5150 /**
5151  * wiphy_dev - get wiphy dev pointer
5152  *
5153  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose device struct to look up
5154  * Return: The dev of @wiphy.
5155  */
5156 static inline struct device *wiphy_dev(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5157 {
5158 	return wiphy->dev.parent;
5159 }
5160 
5161 /**
5162  * wiphy_name - get wiphy name
5163  *
5164  * @wiphy: The wiphy whose name to return
5165  * Return: The name of @wiphy.
5166  */
5167 static inline const char *wiphy_name(const struct wiphy *wiphy)
5168 {
5169 	return dev_name(&wiphy->dev);
5170 }
5171 
5172 /**
5173  * wiphy_new_nm - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5174  *
5175  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5176  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5177  * @requested_name: Request a particular name.
5178  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default phy%d naming.
5179  *
5180  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5181  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5182  *
5183  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5184  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5185  */
5186 struct wiphy *wiphy_new_nm(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops, int sizeof_priv,
5187 			   const char *requested_name);
5188 
5189 /**
5190  * wiphy_new - create a new wiphy for use with cfg80211
5191  *
5192  * @ops: The configuration operations for this device
5193  * @sizeof_priv: The size of the private area to allocate
5194  *
5195  * Create a new wiphy and associate the given operations with it.
5196  * @sizeof_priv bytes are allocated for private use.
5197  *
5198  * Return: A pointer to the new wiphy. This pointer must be
5199  * assigned to each netdev's ieee80211_ptr for proper operation.
5200  */
5201 static inline struct wiphy *wiphy_new(const struct cfg80211_ops *ops,
5202 				      int sizeof_priv)
5203 {
5204 	return wiphy_new_nm(ops, sizeof_priv, NULL);
5205 }
5206 
5207 /**
5208  * wiphy_register - register a wiphy with cfg80211
5209  *
5210  * @wiphy: The wiphy to register.
5211  *
5212  * Return: A non-negative wiphy index or a negative error code.
5213  */
5214 int wiphy_register(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5215 
5216 /* this is a define for better error reporting (file/line) */
5217 #define lockdep_assert_wiphy(wiphy) lockdep_assert_held(&(wiphy)->mtx)
5218 
5219 /**
5220  * rcu_dereference_wiphy - rcu_dereference with debug checking
5221  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5222  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5223  *
5224  * Do an rcu_dereference(p), but check caller either holds rcu_read_lock()
5225  * or RTNL. Note: Please prefer wiphy_dereference() or rcu_dereference().
5226  */
5227 #define rcu_dereference_wiphy(wiphy, p)				\
5228         rcu_dereference_check(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5229 
5230 /**
5231  * wiphy_dereference - fetch RCU pointer when updates are prevented by wiphy mtx
5232  * @wiphy: the wiphy to check the locking on
5233  * @p: The pointer to read, prior to dereferencing
5234  *
5235  * Return the value of the specified RCU-protected pointer, but omit the
5236  * READ_ONCE(), because caller holds the wiphy mutex used for updates.
5237  */
5238 #define wiphy_dereference(wiphy, p)				\
5239         rcu_dereference_protected(p, lockdep_is_held(&wiphy->mtx))
5240 
5241 /**
5242  * get_wiphy_regdom - get custom regdomain for the given wiphy
5243  * @wiphy: the wiphy to get the regdomain from
5244  */
5245 const struct ieee80211_regdomain *get_wiphy_regdom(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5246 
5247 /**
5248  * wiphy_unregister - deregister a wiphy from cfg80211
5249  *
5250  * @wiphy: The wiphy to unregister.
5251  *
5252  * After this call, no more requests can be made with this priv
5253  * pointer, but the call may sleep to wait for an outstanding
5254  * request that is being handled.
5255  */
5256 void wiphy_unregister(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5257 
5258 /**
5259  * wiphy_free - free wiphy
5260  *
5261  * @wiphy: The wiphy to free
5262  */
5263 void wiphy_free(struct wiphy *wiphy);
5264 
5265 /* internal structs */
5266 struct cfg80211_conn;
5267 struct cfg80211_internal_bss;
5268 struct cfg80211_cached_keys;
5269 struct cfg80211_cqm_config;
5270 
5271 /**
5272  * wiphy_lock - lock the wiphy
5273  * @wiphy: the wiphy to lock
5274  *
5275  * This is mostly exposed so it can be done around registering and
5276  * unregistering netdevs that aren't created through cfg80211 calls,
5277  * since that requires locking in cfg80211 when the notifiers is
5278  * called, but that cannot differentiate which way it's called.
5279  *
5280  * When cfg80211 ops are called, the wiphy is already locked.
5281  */
5282 static inline void wiphy_lock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5283 	__acquires(&wiphy->mtx)
5284 {
5285 	mutex_lock(&wiphy->mtx);
5286 	__acquire(&wiphy->mtx);
5287 }
5288 
5289 /**
5290  * wiphy_unlock - unlock the wiphy again
5291  * @wiphy: the wiphy to unlock
5292  */
5293 static inline void wiphy_unlock(struct wiphy *wiphy)
5294 	__releases(&wiphy->mtx)
5295 {
5296 	__release(&wiphy->mtx);
5297 	mutex_unlock(&wiphy->mtx);
5298 }
5299 
5300 /**
5301  * struct wireless_dev - wireless device state
5302  *
5303  * For netdevs, this structure must be allocated by the driver
5304  * that uses the ieee80211_ptr field in struct net_device (this
5305  * is intentional so it can be allocated along with the netdev.)
5306  * It need not be registered then as netdev registration will
5307  * be intercepted by cfg80211 to see the new wireless device,
5308  * however, drivers must lock the wiphy before registering or
5309  * unregistering netdevs if they pre-create any netdevs (in ops
5310  * called from cfg80211, the wiphy is already locked.)
5311  *
5312  * For non-netdev uses, it must also be allocated by the driver
5313  * in response to the cfg80211 callbacks that require it, as
5314  * there's no netdev registration in that case it may not be
5315  * allocated outside of callback operations that return it.
5316  *
5317  * @wiphy: pointer to hardware description
5318  * @iftype: interface type
5319  * @registered: is this wdev already registered with cfg80211
5320  * @registering: indicates we're doing registration under wiphy lock
5321  *	for the notifier
5322  * @list: (private) Used to collect the interfaces
5323  * @netdev: (private) Used to reference back to the netdev, may be %NULL
5324  * @identifier: (private) Identifier used in nl80211 to identify this
5325  *	wireless device if it has no netdev
5326  * @current_bss: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5327  * @chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to track
5328  *	the user-set channel definition.
5329  * @preset_chandef: (private) Used by the internal configuration code to
5330  *	track the channel to be used for AP later
5331  * @bssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5332  * @ssid: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5333  * @ssid_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5334  * @mesh_id_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5335  * @mesh_id_up_len: (private) Used by the internal configuration code
5336  * @wext: (private) Used by the internal wireless extensions compat code
5337  * @wext.ibss: (private) IBSS data part of wext handling
5338  * @wext.connect: (private) connection handling data
5339  * @wext.keys: (private) (WEP) key data
5340  * @wext.ie: (private) extra elements for association
5341  * @wext.ie_len: (private) length of extra elements
5342  * @wext.bssid: (private) selected network BSSID
5343  * @wext.ssid: (private) selected network SSID
5344  * @wext.default_key: (private) selected default key index
5345  * @wext.default_mgmt_key: (private) selected default management key index
5346  * @wext.prev_bssid: (private) previous BSSID for reassociation
5347  * @wext.prev_bssid_valid: (private) previous BSSID validity
5348  * @use_4addr: indicates 4addr mode is used on this interface, must be
5349  *	set by driver (if supported) on add_interface BEFORE registering the
5350  *	netdev and may otherwise be used by driver read-only, will be update
5351  *	by cfg80211 on change_interface
5352  * @mgmt_registrations: list of registrations for management frames
5353  * @mgmt_registrations_lock: lock for the list
5354  * @mgmt_registrations_need_update: mgmt registrations were updated,
5355  *	need to propagate the update to the driver
5356  * @mtx: mutex used to lock data in this struct, may be used by drivers
5357  *	and some API functions require it held
5358  * @beacon_interval: beacon interval used on this device for transmitting
5359  *	beacons, 0 when not valid
5360  * @address: The address for this device, valid only if @netdev is %NULL
5361  * @is_running: true if this is a non-netdev device that has been started, e.g.
5362  *	the P2P Device.
5363  * @cac_started: true if DFS channel availability check has been started
5364  * @cac_start_time: timestamp (jiffies) when the dfs state was entered.
5365  * @cac_time_ms: CAC time in ms
5366  * @ps: powersave mode is enabled
5367  * @ps_timeout: dynamic powersave timeout
5368  * @ap_unexpected_nlportid: (private) netlink port ID of application
5369  *	registered for unexpected class 3 frames (AP mode)
5370  * @conn: (private) cfg80211 software SME connection state machine data
5371  * @connect_keys: (private) keys to set after connection is established
5372  * @conn_bss_type: connecting/connected BSS type
5373  * @conn_owner_nlportid: (private) connection owner socket port ID
5374  * @disconnect_wk: (private) auto-disconnect work
5375  * @disconnect_bssid: (private) the BSSID to use for auto-disconnect
5376  * @ibss_fixed: (private) IBSS is using fixed BSSID
5377  * @ibss_dfs_possible: (private) IBSS may change to a DFS channel
5378  * @event_list: (private) list for internal event processing
5379  * @event_lock: (private) lock for event list
5380  * @owner_nlportid: (private) owner socket port ID
5381  * @nl_owner_dead: (private) owner socket went away
5382  * @cqm_config: (private) nl80211 RSSI monitor state
5383  * @pmsr_list: (private) peer measurement requests
5384  * @pmsr_lock: (private) peer measurements requests/results lock
5385  * @pmsr_free_wk: (private) peer measurements cleanup work
5386  * @unprot_beacon_reported: (private) timestamp of last
5387  *	unprotected beacon report
5388  */
5389 struct wireless_dev {
5390 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
5391 	enum nl80211_iftype iftype;
5392 
5393 	/* the remainder of this struct should be private to cfg80211 */
5394 	struct list_head list;
5395 	struct net_device *netdev;
5396 
5397 	u32 identifier;
5398 
5399 	struct list_head mgmt_registrations;
5400 	spinlock_t mgmt_registrations_lock;
5401 	u8 mgmt_registrations_need_update:1;
5402 
5403 	struct mutex mtx;
5404 
5405 	bool use_4addr, is_running, registered, registering;
5406 
5407 	u8 address[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(sizeof(u16));
5408 
5409 	/* currently used for IBSS and SME - might be rearranged later */
5410 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5411 	u8 ssid_len, mesh_id_len, mesh_id_up_len;
5412 	struct cfg80211_conn *conn;
5413 	struct cfg80211_cached_keys *connect_keys;
5414 	enum ieee80211_bss_type conn_bss_type;
5415 	u32 conn_owner_nlportid;
5416 
5417 	struct work_struct disconnect_wk;
5418 	u8 disconnect_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5419 
5420 	struct list_head event_list;
5421 	spinlock_t event_lock;
5422 
5423 	struct cfg80211_internal_bss *current_bss; /* associated / joined */
5424 	struct cfg80211_chan_def preset_chandef;
5425 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
5426 
5427 	bool ibss_fixed;
5428 	bool ibss_dfs_possible;
5429 
5430 	bool ps;
5431 	int ps_timeout;
5432 
5433 	int beacon_interval;
5434 
5435 	u32 ap_unexpected_nlportid;
5436 
5437 	u32 owner_nlportid;
5438 	bool nl_owner_dead;
5439 
5440 	bool cac_started;
5441 	unsigned long cac_start_time;
5442 	unsigned int cac_time_ms;
5443 
5444 #ifdef CONFIG_CFG80211_WEXT
5445 	/* wext data */
5446 	struct {
5447 		struct cfg80211_ibss_params ibss;
5448 		struct cfg80211_connect_params connect;
5449 		struct cfg80211_cached_keys *keys;
5450 		const u8 *ie;
5451 		size_t ie_len;
5452 		u8 bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5453 		u8 prev_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
5454 		u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
5455 		s8 default_key, default_mgmt_key;
5456 		bool prev_bssid_valid;
5457 	} wext;
5458 #endif
5459 
5460 	struct cfg80211_cqm_config *cqm_config;
5461 
5462 	struct list_head pmsr_list;
5463 	spinlock_t pmsr_lock;
5464 	struct work_struct pmsr_free_wk;
5465 
5466 	unsigned long unprot_beacon_reported;
5467 };
5468 
5469 static inline u8 *wdev_address(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5470 {
5471 	if (wdev->netdev)
5472 		return wdev->netdev->dev_addr;
5473 	return wdev->address;
5474 }
5475 
5476 static inline bool wdev_running(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5477 {
5478 	if (wdev->netdev)
5479 		return netif_running(wdev->netdev);
5480 	return wdev->is_running;
5481 }
5482 
5483 /**
5484  * wdev_priv - return wiphy priv from wireless_dev
5485  *
5486  * @wdev: The wireless device whose wiphy's priv pointer to return
5487  * Return: The wiphy priv of @wdev.
5488  */
5489 static inline void *wdev_priv(struct wireless_dev *wdev)
5490 {
5491 	BUG_ON(!wdev);
5492 	return wiphy_priv(wdev->wiphy);
5493 }
5494 
5495 /**
5496  * DOC: Utility functions
5497  *
5498  * cfg80211 offers a number of utility functions that can be useful.
5499  */
5500 
5501 /**
5502  * ieee80211_channel_equal - compare two struct ieee80211_channel
5503  *
5504  * @a: 1st struct ieee80211_channel
5505  * @b: 2nd struct ieee80211_channel
5506  * Return: true if center frequency of @a == @b
5507  */
5508 static inline bool
5509 ieee80211_channel_equal(struct ieee80211_channel *a,
5510 			struct ieee80211_channel *b)
5511 {
5512 	return (a->center_freq == b->center_freq &&
5513 		a->freq_offset == b->freq_offset);
5514 }
5515 
5516 /**
5517  * ieee80211_channel_to_khz - convert ieee80211_channel to frequency in KHz
5518  * @chan: struct ieee80211_channel to convert
5519  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz)
5520  */
5521 static inline u32
5522 ieee80211_channel_to_khz(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5523 {
5524 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chan->center_freq) + chan->freq_offset;
5525 }
5526 
5527 /**
5528  * ieee80211_s1g_channel_width - get allowed channel width from @chan
5529  *
5530  * Only allowed for band NL80211_BAND_S1GHZ
5531  * @chan: channel
5532  * Return: The allowed channel width for this center_freq
5533  */
5534 enum nl80211_chan_width
5535 ieee80211_s1g_channel_width(const struct ieee80211_channel *chan);
5536 
5537 /**
5538  * ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz - convert channel number to frequency
5539  * @chan: channel number
5540  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5541  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in KHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5542  */
5543 u32 ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(int chan, enum nl80211_band band);
5544 
5545 /**
5546  * ieee80211_channel_to_frequency - convert channel number to frequency
5547  * @chan: channel number
5548  * @band: band, necessary due to channel number overlap
5549  * Return: The corresponding frequency (in MHz), or 0 if the conversion failed.
5550  */
5551 static inline int
5552 ieee80211_channel_to_frequency(int chan, enum nl80211_band band)
5553 {
5554 	return KHZ_TO_MHZ(ieee80211_channel_to_freq_khz(chan, band));
5555 }
5556 
5557 /**
5558  * ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5559  * @freq: center frequency in KHz
5560  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5561  */
5562 int ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(u32 freq);
5563 
5564 /**
5565  * ieee80211_frequency_to_channel - convert frequency to channel number
5566  * @freq: center frequency in MHz
5567  * Return: The corresponding channel, or 0 if the conversion failed.
5568  */
5569 static inline int
5570 ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(int freq)
5571 {
5572 	return ieee80211_freq_khz_to_channel(MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5573 }
5574 
5575 /**
5576  * ieee80211_get_channel_khz - get channel struct from wiphy for specified
5577  * frequency
5578  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5579  * @freq: the center frequency (in KHz) of the channel
5580  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5581  */
5582 struct ieee80211_channel *
5583 ieee80211_get_channel_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, u32 freq);
5584 
5585 /**
5586  * ieee80211_get_channel - get channel struct from wiphy for specified frequency
5587  *
5588  * @wiphy: the struct wiphy to get the channel for
5589  * @freq: the center frequency (in MHz) of the channel
5590  * Return: The channel struct from @wiphy at @freq.
5591  */
5592 static inline struct ieee80211_channel *
5593 ieee80211_get_channel(struct wiphy *wiphy, int freq)
5594 {
5595 	return ieee80211_get_channel_khz(wiphy, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq));
5596 }
5597 
5598 /**
5599  * cfg80211_channel_is_psc - Check if the channel is a 6 GHz PSC
5600  * @chan: control channel to check
5601  *
5602  * The Preferred Scanning Channels (PSC) are defined in
5603  * Draft IEEE P802.11ax/D5.0, 26.17.2.3.3
5604  */
5605 static inline bool cfg80211_channel_is_psc(struct ieee80211_channel *chan)
5606 {
5607 	if (chan->band != NL80211_BAND_6GHZ)
5608 		return false;
5609 
5610 	return ieee80211_frequency_to_channel(chan->center_freq) % 16 == 5;
5611 }
5612 
5613 /**
5614  * ieee80211_get_response_rate - get basic rate for a given rate
5615  *
5616  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5617  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates
5618  * @bitrate: the bitrate for which to find the basic rate
5619  *
5620  * Return: The basic rate corresponding to a given bitrate, that
5621  * is the next lower bitrate contained in the basic rate map,
5622  * which is, for this function, given as a bitmap of indices of
5623  * rates in the band's bitrate table.
5624  */
5625 const struct ieee80211_rate *
5626 ieee80211_get_response_rate(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5627 			    u32 basic_rates, int bitrate);
5628 
5629 /**
5630  * ieee80211_mandatory_rates - get mandatory rates for a given band
5631  * @sband: the band to look for rates in
5632  * @scan_width: width of the control channel
5633  *
5634  * This function returns a bitmap of the mandatory rates for the given
5635  * band, bits are set according to the rate position in the bitrates array.
5636  */
5637 u32 ieee80211_mandatory_rates(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5638 			      enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width);
5639 
5640 /*
5641  * Radiotap parsing functions -- for controlled injection support
5642  *
5643  * Implemented in net/wireless/radiotap.c
5644  * Documentation in Documentation/networking/radiotap-headers.rst
5645  */
5646 
5647 struct radiotap_align_size {
5648 	uint8_t align:4, size:4;
5649 };
5650 
5651 struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace {
5652 	const struct radiotap_align_size *align_size;
5653 	int n_bits;
5654 	uint32_t oui;
5655 	uint8_t subns;
5656 };
5657 
5658 struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces {
5659 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *ns;
5660 	int n_ns;
5661 };
5662 
5663 /**
5664  * struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator - tracks walk thru present radiotap args
5665  * @this_arg_index: index of current arg, valid after each successful call
5666  *	to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next()
5667  * @this_arg: pointer to current radiotap arg; it is valid after each
5668  *	call to ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next() but also after
5669  *	ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init() where it will point to
5670  *	the beginning of the actual data portion
5671  * @this_arg_size: length of the current arg, for convenience
5672  * @current_namespace: pointer to the current namespace definition
5673  *	(or internally %NULL if the current namespace is unknown)
5674  * @is_radiotap_ns: indicates whether the current namespace is the default
5675  *	radiotap namespace or not
5676  *
5677  * @_rtheader: pointer to the radiotap header we are walking through
5678  * @_max_length: length of radiotap header in cpu byte ordering
5679  * @_arg_index: next argument index
5680  * @_arg: next argument pointer
5681  * @_next_bitmap: internal pointer to next present u32
5682  * @_bitmap_shifter: internal shifter for curr u32 bitmap, b0 set == arg present
5683  * @_vns: vendor namespace definitions
5684  * @_next_ns_data: beginning of the next namespace's data
5685  * @_reset_on_ext: internal; reset the arg index to 0 when going to the
5686  *	next bitmap word
5687  *
5688  * Describes the radiotap parser state. Fields prefixed with an underscore
5689  * must not be used by users of the parser, only by the parser internally.
5690  */
5691 
5692 struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator {
5693 	struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *_rtheader;
5694 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *_vns;
5695 	const struct ieee80211_radiotap_namespace *current_namespace;
5696 
5697 	unsigned char *_arg, *_next_ns_data;
5698 	__le32 *_next_bitmap;
5699 
5700 	unsigned char *this_arg;
5701 	int this_arg_index;
5702 	int this_arg_size;
5703 
5704 	int is_radiotap_ns;
5705 
5706 	int _max_length;
5707 	int _arg_index;
5708 	uint32_t _bitmap_shifter;
5709 	int _reset_on_ext;
5710 };
5711 
5712 int
5713 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_init(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator,
5714 				 struct ieee80211_radiotap_header *radiotap_header,
5715 				 int max_length,
5716 				 const struct ieee80211_radiotap_vendor_namespaces *vns);
5717 
5718 int
5719 ieee80211_radiotap_iterator_next(struct ieee80211_radiotap_iterator *iterator);
5720 
5721 
5722 extern const unsigned char rfc1042_header[6];
5723 extern const unsigned char bridge_tunnel_header[6];
5724 
5725 /**
5726  * ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb - get header length from data
5727  *
5728  * @skb: the frame
5729  *
5730  * Given an skb with a raw 802.11 header at the data pointer this function
5731  * returns the 802.11 header length.
5732  *
5733  * Return: The 802.11 header length in bytes (not including encryption
5734  * headers). Or 0 if the data in the sk_buff is too short to contain a valid
5735  * 802.11 header.
5736  */
5737 unsigned int ieee80211_get_hdrlen_from_skb(const struct sk_buff *skb);
5738 
5739 /**
5740  * ieee80211_hdrlen - get header length in bytes from frame control
5741  * @fc: frame control field in little-endian format
5742  * Return: The header length in bytes.
5743  */
5744 unsigned int __attribute_const__ ieee80211_hdrlen(__le16 fc);
5745 
5746 /**
5747  * ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen - get mesh extension header length
5748  * @meshhdr: the mesh extension header, only the flags field
5749  *	(first byte) will be accessed
5750  * Return: The length of the extension header, which is always at
5751  * least 6 bytes and at most 18 if address 5 and 6 are present.
5752  */
5753 unsigned int ieee80211_get_mesh_hdrlen(struct ieee80211s_hdr *meshhdr);
5754 
5755 /**
5756  * DOC: Data path helpers
5757  *
5758  * In addition to generic utilities, cfg80211 also offers
5759  * functions that help implement the data path for devices
5760  * that do not do the 802.11/802.3 conversion on the device.
5761  */
5762 
5763 /**
5764  * ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5765  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5766  * @ehdr: pointer to a &struct ethhdr that will get the header, instead
5767  *	of it being pushed into the SKB
5768  * @addr: the device MAC address
5769  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5770  * @data_offset: offset of payload after the 802.11 header
5771  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5772  */
5773 int ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(struct sk_buff *skb, struct ethhdr *ehdr,
5774 				  const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5775 				  u8 data_offset, bool is_amsdu);
5776 
5777 /**
5778  * ieee80211_data_to_8023 - convert an 802.11 data frame to 802.3
5779  * @skb: the 802.11 data frame
5780  * @addr: the device MAC address
5781  * @iftype: the virtual interface type
5782  * Return: 0 on success. Non-zero on error.
5783  */
5784 static inline int ieee80211_data_to_8023(struct sk_buff *skb, const u8 *addr,
5785 					 enum nl80211_iftype iftype)
5786 {
5787 	return ieee80211_data_to_8023_exthdr(skb, NULL, addr, iftype, 0, false);
5788 }
5789 
5790 /**
5791  * ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s - decode an IEEE 802.11n A-MSDU frame
5792  *
5793  * Decode an IEEE 802.11 A-MSDU and convert it to a list of 802.3 frames.
5794  * The @list will be empty if the decode fails. The @skb must be fully
5795  * header-less before being passed in here; it is freed in this function.
5796  *
5797  * @skb: The input A-MSDU frame without any headers.
5798  * @list: The output list of 802.3 frames. It must be allocated and
5799  *	initialized by the caller.
5800  * @addr: The device MAC address.
5801  * @iftype: The device interface type.
5802  * @extra_headroom: The hardware extra headroom for SKBs in the @list.
5803  * @check_da: DA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5804  * @check_sa: SA to check in the inner ethernet header, or NULL
5805  */
5806 void ieee80211_amsdu_to_8023s(struct sk_buff *skb, struct sk_buff_head *list,
5807 			      const u8 *addr, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
5808 			      const unsigned int extra_headroom,
5809 			      const u8 *check_da, const u8 *check_sa);
5810 
5811 /**
5812  * cfg80211_classify8021d - determine the 802.1p/1d tag for a data frame
5813  * @skb: the data frame
5814  * @qos_map: Interworking QoS mapping or %NULL if not in use
5815  * Return: The 802.1p/1d tag.
5816  */
5817 unsigned int cfg80211_classify8021d(struct sk_buff *skb,
5818 				    struct cfg80211_qos_map *qos_map);
5819 
5820 /**
5821  * cfg80211_find_elem_match - match information element and byte array in data
5822  *
5823  * @eid: element ID
5824  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5825  * @len: length of data
5826  * @match: byte array to match
5827  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5828  * @match_offset: offset in the IE data where the byte array should match.
5829  *	Note the difference to cfg80211_find_ie_match() which considers
5830  *	the offset to start from the element ID byte, but here we take
5831  *	the data portion instead.
5832  *
5833  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5834  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5835  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5836  * requested element struct.
5837  *
5838  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5839  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5840  * byte array to match.
5841  */
5842 const struct element *
5843 cfg80211_find_elem_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5844 			 const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5845 			 unsigned int match_offset);
5846 
5847 /**
5848  * cfg80211_find_ie_match - match information element and byte array in data
5849  *
5850  * @eid: element ID
5851  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5852  * @len: length of data
5853  * @match: byte array to match
5854  * @match_len: number of bytes in the match array
5855  * @match_offset: offset in the IE where the byte array should match.
5856  *	If match_len is zero, this must also be set to zero.
5857  *	Otherwise this must be set to 2 or more, because the first
5858  *	byte is the element id, which is already compared to eid, and
5859  *	the second byte is the IE length.
5860  *
5861  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5862  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5863  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match, or a pointer to the first
5864  * byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
5865  * element ID.
5866  *
5867  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5868  * having to fit into the given data and being large enough for the
5869  * byte array to match.
5870  */
5871 static inline const u8 *
5872 cfg80211_find_ie_match(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
5873 		       const u8 *match, unsigned int match_len,
5874 		       unsigned int match_offset)
5875 {
5876 	/* match_offset can't be smaller than 2, unless match_len is
5877 	 * zero, in which case match_offset must be zero as well.
5878 	 */
5879 	if (WARN_ON((match_len && match_offset < 2) ||
5880 		    (!match_len && match_offset)))
5881 		return NULL;
5882 
5883 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len,
5884 						match, match_len,
5885 						match_offset ?
5886 							match_offset - 2 : 0);
5887 }
5888 
5889 /**
5890  * cfg80211_find_elem - find information element in data
5891  *
5892  * @eid: element ID
5893  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5894  * @len: length of data
5895  *
5896  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5897  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5898  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5899  * requested element struct.
5900  *
5901  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5902  * having to fit into the given data.
5903  */
5904 static inline const struct element *
5905 cfg80211_find_elem(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5906 {
5907 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5908 }
5909 
5910 /**
5911  * cfg80211_find_ie - find information element in data
5912  *
5913  * @eid: element ID
5914  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5915  * @len: length of data
5916  *
5917  * Return: %NULL if the element ID could not be found or if
5918  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5919  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5920  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5921  *
5922  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5923  * having to fit into the given data.
5924  */
5925 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ie(u8 eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5926 {
5927 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(eid, ies, len, NULL, 0, 0);
5928 }
5929 
5930 /**
5931  * cfg80211_find_ext_elem - find information element with EID Extension in data
5932  *
5933  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5934  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5935  * @len: length of data
5936  *
5937  * Return: %NULL if the etended element could not be found or if
5938  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5939  * data) or if the byte array doesn't match; otherwise return the
5940  * requested element struct.
5941  *
5942  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5943  * having to fit into the given data.
5944  */
5945 static inline const struct element *
5946 cfg80211_find_ext_elem(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5947 {
5948 	return cfg80211_find_elem_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5949 					&ext_eid, 1, 0);
5950 }
5951 
5952 /**
5953  * cfg80211_find_ext_ie - find information element with EID Extension in data
5954  *
5955  * @ext_eid: element ID Extension
5956  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5957  * @len: length of data
5958  *
5959  * Return: %NULL if the extended element ID could not be found or if
5960  * the element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given
5961  * data), or a pointer to the first byte of the requested
5962  * element, that is the byte containing the element ID.
5963  *
5964  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than
5965  * having to fit into the given data.
5966  */
5967 static inline const u8 *cfg80211_find_ext_ie(u8 ext_eid, const u8 *ies, int len)
5968 {
5969 	return cfg80211_find_ie_match(WLAN_EID_EXTENSION, ies, len,
5970 				      &ext_eid, 1, 2);
5971 }
5972 
5973 /**
5974  * cfg80211_find_vendor_elem - find vendor specific information element in data
5975  *
5976  * @oui: vendor OUI
5977  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5978  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5979  * @len: length of data
5980  *
5981  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
5982  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data); otherwise
5983  * return the element structure for the requested element.
5984  *
5985  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
5986  * the given data.
5987  */
5988 const struct element *cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
5989 						const u8 *ies,
5990 						unsigned int len);
5991 
5992 /**
5993  * cfg80211_find_vendor_ie - find vendor specific information element in data
5994  *
5995  * @oui: vendor OUI
5996  * @oui_type: vendor-specific OUI type (must be < 0xff), negative means any
5997  * @ies: data consisting of IEs
5998  * @len: length of data
5999  *
6000  * Return: %NULL if the vendor specific element ID could not be found or if the
6001  * element is invalid (claims to be longer than the given data), or a pointer to
6002  * the first byte of the requested element, that is the byte containing the
6003  * element ID.
6004  *
6005  * Note: There are no checks on the element length other than having to fit into
6006  * the given data.
6007  */
6008 static inline const u8 *
6009 cfg80211_find_vendor_ie(unsigned int oui, int oui_type,
6010 			const u8 *ies, unsigned int len)
6011 {
6012 	return (void *)cfg80211_find_vendor_elem(oui, oui_type, ies, len);
6013 }
6014 
6015 /**
6016  * cfg80211_send_layer2_update - send layer 2 update frame
6017  *
6018  * @dev: network device
6019  * @addr: STA MAC address
6020  *
6021  * Wireless drivers can use this function to update forwarding tables in bridge
6022  * devices upon STA association.
6023  */
6024 void cfg80211_send_layer2_update(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6025 
6026 /**
6027  * DOC: Regulatory enforcement infrastructure
6028  *
6029  * TODO
6030  */
6031 
6032 /**
6033  * regulatory_hint - driver hint to the wireless core a regulatory domain
6034  * @wiphy: the wireless device giving the hint (used only for reporting
6035  *	conflicts)
6036  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 the driver claims its regulatory domain
6037  *	should be in. If @rd is set this should be NULL. Note that if you
6038  *	set this to NULL you should still set rd->alpha2 to some accepted
6039  *	alpha2.
6040  *
6041  * Wireless drivers can use this function to hint to the wireless core
6042  * what it believes should be the current regulatory domain by
6043  * giving it an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country code it knows its regulatory
6044  * domain should be in or by providing a completely build regulatory domain.
6045  * If the driver provides an ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 userspace will be queried
6046  * for a regulatory domain structure for the respective country.
6047  *
6048  * The wiphy must have been registered to cfg80211 prior to this call.
6049  * For cfg80211 drivers this means you must first use wiphy_register(),
6050  * for mac80211 drivers you must first use ieee80211_register_hw().
6051  *
6052  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6053  * an -ENOMEM.
6054  *
6055  * Return: 0 on success. -ENOMEM.
6056  */
6057 int regulatory_hint(struct wiphy *wiphy, const char *alpha2);
6058 
6059 /**
6060  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd - set regdom info for self managed drivers
6061  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6062  * @rd: the regulatory domain informatoin to use for this wiphy
6063  *
6064  * Set the regulatory domain information for self-managed wiphys, only they
6065  * may use this function. See %REGULATORY_WIPHY_SELF_MANAGED for more
6066  * information.
6067  *
6068  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6069  */
6070 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6071 			      struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6072 
6073 /**
6074  * regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync - set regdom for self-managed drivers
6075  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6076  * @rd: the regulatory domain information to use for this wiphy
6077  *
6078  * This functions requires the RTNL and the wiphy mutex to be held and
6079  * applies the new regdomain synchronously to this wiphy. For more details
6080  * see regulatory_set_wiphy_regd().
6081  *
6082  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL, -EPERM
6083  */
6084 int regulatory_set_wiphy_regd_sync(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6085 				   struct ieee80211_regdomain *rd);
6086 
6087 /**
6088  * wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory - apply a custom driver regulatory domain
6089  * @wiphy: the wireless device we want to process the regulatory domain on
6090  * @regd: the custom regulatory domain to use for this wiphy
6091  *
6092  * Drivers can sometimes have custom regulatory domains which do not apply
6093  * to a specific country. Drivers can use this to apply such custom regulatory
6094  * domains. This routine must be called prior to wiphy registration. The
6095  * custom regulatory domain will be trusted completely and as such previous
6096  * default channel settings will be disregarded. If no rule is found for a
6097  * channel on the regulatory domain the channel will be disabled.
6098  * Drivers using this for a wiphy should also set the wiphy flag
6099  * REGULATORY_CUSTOM_REG or cfg80211 will set it for the wiphy
6100  * that called this helper.
6101  */
6102 void wiphy_apply_custom_regulatory(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6103 				   const struct ieee80211_regdomain *regd);
6104 
6105 /**
6106  * freq_reg_info - get regulatory information for the given frequency
6107  * @wiphy: the wiphy for which we want to process this rule for
6108  * @center_freq: Frequency in KHz for which we want regulatory information for
6109  *
6110  * Use this function to get the regulatory rule for a specific frequency on
6111  * a given wireless device. If the device has a specific regulatory domain
6112  * it wants to follow we respect that unless a country IE has been received
6113  * and processed already.
6114  *
6115  * Return: A valid pointer, or, when an error occurs, for example if no rule
6116  * can be found, the return value is encoded using ERR_PTR(). Use IS_ERR() to
6117  * check and PTR_ERR() to obtain the numeric return value. The numeric return
6118  * value will be -ERANGE if we determine the given center_freq does not even
6119  * have a regulatory rule for a frequency range in the center_freq's band.
6120  * See freq_in_rule_band() for our current definition of a band -- this is
6121  * purely subjective and right now it's 802.11 specific.
6122  */
6123 const struct ieee80211_reg_rule *freq_reg_info(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6124 					       u32 center_freq);
6125 
6126 /**
6127  * reg_initiator_name - map regulatory request initiator enum to name
6128  * @initiator: the regulatory request initiator
6129  *
6130  * You can use this to map the regulatory request initiator enum to a
6131  * proper string representation.
6132  */
6133 const char *reg_initiator_name(enum nl80211_reg_initiator initiator);
6134 
6135 /**
6136  * regulatory_pre_cac_allowed - check if pre-CAC allowed in the current regdom
6137  * @wiphy: wiphy for which pre-CAC capability is checked.
6138  *
6139  * Pre-CAC is allowed only in some regdomains (notable ETSI).
6140  */
6141 bool regulatory_pre_cac_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6142 
6143 /**
6144  * DOC: Internal regulatory db functions
6145  *
6146  */
6147 
6148 /**
6149  * reg_query_regdb_wmm -  Query internal regulatory db for wmm rule
6150  * Regulatory self-managed driver can use it to proactively
6151  *
6152  * @alpha2: the ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 wmm rule to be queried.
6153  * @freq: the freqency(in MHz) to be queried.
6154  * @rule: pointer to store the wmm rule from the regulatory db.
6155  *
6156  * Self-managed wireless drivers can use this function to  query
6157  * the internal regulatory database to check whether the given
6158  * ISO/IEC 3166 alpha2 country and freq have wmm rule limitations.
6159  *
6160  * Drivers should check the return value, its possible you can get
6161  * an -ENODATA.
6162  *
6163  * Return: 0 on success. -ENODATA.
6164  */
6165 int reg_query_regdb_wmm(char *alpha2, int freq,
6166 			struct ieee80211_reg_rule *rule);
6167 
6168 /*
6169  * callbacks for asynchronous cfg80211 methods, notification
6170  * functions and BSS handling helpers
6171  */
6172 
6173 /**
6174  * cfg80211_scan_done - notify that scan finished
6175  *
6176  * @request: the corresponding scan request
6177  * @info: information about the completed scan
6178  */
6179 void cfg80211_scan_done(struct cfg80211_scan_request *request,
6180 			struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6181 
6182 /**
6183  * cfg80211_sched_scan_results - notify that new scan results are available
6184  *
6185  * @wiphy: the wiphy which got scheduled scan results
6186  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6187  */
6188 void cfg80211_sched_scan_results(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6189 
6190 /**
6191  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6192  *
6193  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6194  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6195  *
6196  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6197  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6198  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6199  */
6200 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6201 
6202 /**
6203  * cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked - notify that the scheduled scan has stopped
6204  *
6205  * @wiphy: the wiphy on which the scheduled scan stopped
6206  * @reqid: identifier for the related scheduled scan request
6207  *
6208  * The driver can call this function to inform cfg80211 that the
6209  * scheduled scan had to be stopped, for whatever reason.  The driver
6210  * is then called back via the sched_scan_stop operation when done.
6211  * This function should be called with the wiphy mutex held.
6212  */
6213 void cfg80211_sched_scan_stopped_locked(struct wiphy *wiphy, u64 reqid);
6214 
6215 /**
6216  * cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data - inform cfg80211 of a received BSS frame
6217  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6218  * @data: the BSS metadata
6219  * @mgmt: the management frame (probe response or beacon)
6220  * @len: length of the management frame
6221  * @gfp: context flags
6222  *
6223  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6224  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6225  *
6226  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6227  * Or %NULL on error.
6228  */
6229 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6230 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6231 			       struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6232 			       struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6233 			       gfp_t gfp);
6234 
6235 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6236 cfg80211_inform_bss_width_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6237 				struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6238 				enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6239 				struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6240 				s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6241 {
6242 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6243 		.chan = rx_channel,
6244 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6245 		.signal = signal,
6246 	};
6247 
6248 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6249 }
6250 
6251 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6252 cfg80211_inform_bss_frame(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6253 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6254 			  struct ieee80211_mgmt *mgmt, size_t len,
6255 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6256 {
6257 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6258 		.chan = rx_channel,
6259 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6260 		.signal = signal,
6261 	};
6262 
6263 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_frame_data(wiphy, &data, mgmt, len, gfp);
6264 }
6265 
6266 /**
6267  * cfg80211_gen_new_bssid - generate a nontransmitted BSSID for multi-BSSID
6268  * @bssid: transmitter BSSID
6269  * @max_bssid: max BSSID indicator, taken from Multiple BSSID element
6270  * @mbssid_index: BSSID index, taken from Multiple BSSID index element
6271  * @new_bssid: calculated nontransmitted BSSID
6272  */
6273 static inline void cfg80211_gen_new_bssid(const u8 *bssid, u8 max_bssid,
6274 					  u8 mbssid_index, u8 *new_bssid)
6275 {
6276 	u64 bssid_u64 = ether_addr_to_u64(bssid);
6277 	u64 mask = GENMASK_ULL(max_bssid - 1, 0);
6278 	u64 new_bssid_u64;
6279 
6280 	new_bssid_u64 = bssid_u64 & ~mask;
6281 
6282 	new_bssid_u64 |= ((bssid_u64 & mask) + mbssid_index) & mask;
6283 
6284 	u64_to_ether_addr(new_bssid_u64, new_bssid);
6285 }
6286 
6287 /**
6288  * cfg80211_is_element_inherited - returns if element ID should be inherited
6289  * @element: element to check
6290  * @non_inherit_element: non inheritance element
6291  */
6292 bool cfg80211_is_element_inherited(const struct element *element,
6293 				   const struct element *non_inherit_element);
6294 
6295 /**
6296  * cfg80211_merge_profile - merges a MBSSID profile if it is split between IEs
6297  * @ie: ies
6298  * @ielen: length of IEs
6299  * @mbssid_elem: current MBSSID element
6300  * @sub_elem: current MBSSID subelement (profile)
6301  * @merged_ie: location of the merged profile
6302  * @max_copy_len: max merged profile length
6303  */
6304 size_t cfg80211_merge_profile(const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6305 			      const struct element *mbssid_elem,
6306 			      const struct element *sub_elem,
6307 			      u8 *merged_ie, size_t max_copy_len);
6308 
6309 /**
6310  * enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type - frame type that the BSS data came from
6311  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN: driver doesn't know whether the data is
6312  *	from a beacon or probe response
6313  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON: data comes from a beacon
6314  * @CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP: data comes from a probe response
6315  */
6316 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type {
6317 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_UNKNOWN,
6318 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_BEACON,
6319 	CFG80211_BSS_FTYPE_PRESP,
6320 };
6321 
6322 /**
6323  * cfg80211_inform_bss_data - inform cfg80211 of a new BSS
6324  *
6325  * @wiphy: the wiphy reporting the BSS
6326  * @data: the BSS metadata
6327  * @ftype: frame type (if known)
6328  * @bssid: the BSSID of the BSS
6329  * @tsf: the TSF sent by the peer in the beacon/probe response (or 0)
6330  * @capability: the capability field sent by the peer
6331  * @beacon_interval: the beacon interval announced by the peer
6332  * @ie: additional IEs sent by the peer
6333  * @ielen: length of the additional IEs
6334  * @gfp: context flags
6335  *
6336  * This informs cfg80211 that BSS information was found and
6337  * the BSS should be updated/added.
6338  *
6339  * Return: A referenced struct, must be released with cfg80211_put_bss()!
6340  * Or %NULL on error.
6341  */
6342 struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6343 cfg80211_inform_bss_data(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6344 			 struct cfg80211_inform_bss *data,
6345 			 enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6346 			 const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6347 			 u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6348 			 gfp_t gfp);
6349 
6350 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6351 cfg80211_inform_bss_width(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6352 			  struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6353 			  enum nl80211_bss_scan_width scan_width,
6354 			  enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6355 			  const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6356 			  u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6357 			  s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6358 {
6359 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6360 		.chan = rx_channel,
6361 		.scan_width = scan_width,
6362 		.signal = signal,
6363 	};
6364 
6365 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6366 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6367 					gfp);
6368 }
6369 
6370 static inline struct cfg80211_bss * __must_check
6371 cfg80211_inform_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6372 		    struct ieee80211_channel *rx_channel,
6373 		    enum cfg80211_bss_frame_type ftype,
6374 		    const u8 *bssid, u64 tsf, u16 capability,
6375 		    u16 beacon_interval, const u8 *ie, size_t ielen,
6376 		    s32 signal, gfp_t gfp)
6377 {
6378 	struct cfg80211_inform_bss data = {
6379 		.chan = rx_channel,
6380 		.scan_width = NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20,
6381 		.signal = signal,
6382 	};
6383 
6384 	return cfg80211_inform_bss_data(wiphy, &data, ftype, bssid, tsf,
6385 					capability, beacon_interval, ie, ielen,
6386 					gfp);
6387 }
6388 
6389 /**
6390  * cfg80211_get_bss - get a BSS reference
6391  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6392  * @channel: the channel to search on (or %NULL)
6393  * @bssid: the desired BSSID (or %NULL)
6394  * @ssid: the desired SSID (or %NULL)
6395  * @ssid_len: length of the SSID (or 0)
6396  * @bss_type: type of BSS, see &enum ieee80211_bss_type
6397  * @privacy: privacy filter, see &enum ieee80211_privacy
6398  */
6399 struct cfg80211_bss *cfg80211_get_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6400 				      struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6401 				      const u8 *bssid,
6402 				      const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
6403 				      enum ieee80211_bss_type bss_type,
6404 				      enum ieee80211_privacy privacy);
6405 static inline struct cfg80211_bss *
6406 cfg80211_get_ibss(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6407 		  struct ieee80211_channel *channel,
6408 		  const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len)
6409 {
6410 	return cfg80211_get_bss(wiphy, channel, NULL, ssid, ssid_len,
6411 				IEEE80211_BSS_TYPE_IBSS,
6412 				IEEE80211_PRIVACY_ANY);
6413 }
6414 
6415 /**
6416  * cfg80211_ref_bss - reference BSS struct
6417  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6418  * @bss: the BSS struct to reference
6419  *
6420  * Increments the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6421  */
6422 void cfg80211_ref_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6423 
6424 /**
6425  * cfg80211_put_bss - unref BSS struct
6426  * @wiphy: the wiphy this BSS struct belongs to
6427  * @bss: the BSS struct
6428  *
6429  * Decrements the refcount of the given BSS struct.
6430  */
6431 void cfg80211_put_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6432 
6433 /**
6434  * cfg80211_unlink_bss - unlink BSS from internal data structures
6435  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6436  * @bss: the bss to remove
6437  *
6438  * This function removes the given BSS from the internal data structures
6439  * thereby making it no longer show up in scan results etc. Use this
6440  * function when you detect a BSS is gone. Normally BSSes will also time
6441  * out, so it is not necessary to use this function at all.
6442  */
6443 void cfg80211_unlink_bss(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6444 
6445 /**
6446  * cfg80211_bss_iter - iterate all BSS entries
6447  *
6448  * This function iterates over the BSS entries associated with the given wiphy
6449  * and calls the callback for the iterated BSS. The iterator function is not
6450  * allowed to call functions that might modify the internal state of the BSS DB.
6451  *
6452  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6453  * @chandef: if given, the iterator function will be called only if the channel
6454  *     of the currently iterated BSS is a subset of the given channel.
6455  * @iter: the iterator function to call
6456  * @iter_data: an argument to the iterator function
6457  */
6458 void cfg80211_bss_iter(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6459 		       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6460 		       void (*iter)(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6461 				    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6462 				    void *data),
6463 		       void *iter_data);
6464 
6465 static inline enum nl80211_bss_scan_width
6466 cfg80211_chandef_to_scan_width(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
6467 {
6468 	switch (chandef->width) {
6469 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5:
6470 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_5;
6471 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10:
6472 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_10;
6473 	default:
6474 		return NL80211_BSS_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6475 	}
6476 }
6477 
6478 /**
6479  * cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt - notification of processed MLME management frame
6480  * @dev: network device
6481  * @buf: authentication frame (header + body)
6482  * @len: length of the frame data
6483  *
6484  * This function is called whenever an authentication, disassociation or
6485  * deauthentication frame has been received and processed in station mode.
6486  * After being asked to authenticate via cfg80211_ops::auth() the driver must
6487  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6488  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6489  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6490  * While connected, the driver must calls this for received and processed
6491  * disassociation and deauthentication frames. If the frame couldn't be used
6492  * because it was unprotected, the driver must call the function
6493  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt() instead.
6494  *
6495  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6496  */
6497 void cfg80211_rx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6498 
6499 /**
6500  * cfg80211_auth_timeout - notification of timed out authentication
6501  * @dev: network device
6502  * @addr: The MAC address of the device with which the authentication timed out
6503  *
6504  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's
6505  * mutex.
6506  */
6507 void cfg80211_auth_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr);
6508 
6509 /**
6510  * cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp - notification of processed association response
6511  * @dev: network device
6512  * @bss: the BSS that association was requested with, ownership of the pointer
6513  *	moves to cfg80211 in this call
6514  * @buf: (Re)Association Response frame (header + body)
6515  * @len: length of the frame data
6516  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Same format
6517  *	as the AC bitmap in the QoS info field
6518  * @req_ies: information elements from the (Re)Association Request frame
6519  * @req_ies_len: length of req_ies data
6520  *
6521  * After being asked to associate via cfg80211_ops::assoc() the driver must
6522  * call either this function or cfg80211_auth_timeout().
6523  *
6524  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6525  */
6526 void cfg80211_rx_assoc_resp(struct net_device *dev,
6527 			    struct cfg80211_bss *bss,
6528 			    const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6529 			    int uapsd_queues,
6530 			    const u8 *req_ies, size_t req_ies_len);
6531 
6532 /**
6533  * cfg80211_assoc_timeout - notification of timed out association
6534  * @dev: network device
6535  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association timed out.
6536  *
6537  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6538  */
6539 void cfg80211_assoc_timeout(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6540 
6541 /**
6542  * cfg80211_abandon_assoc - notify cfg80211 of abandoned association attempt
6543  * @dev: network device
6544  * @bss: The BSS entry with which association was abandoned.
6545  *
6546  * Call this whenever - for reasons reported through other API, like deauth RX,
6547  * an association attempt was abandoned.
6548  * This function may sleep. The caller must hold the corresponding wdev's mutex.
6549  */
6550 void cfg80211_abandon_assoc(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_bss *bss);
6551 
6552 /**
6553  * cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt - notification of transmitted deauth/disassoc frame
6554  * @dev: network device
6555  * @buf: 802.11 frame (header + body)
6556  * @len: length of the frame data
6557  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired (include the nl80211 attribute)
6558  *
6559  * This function is called whenever deauthentication has been processed in
6560  * station mode. This includes both received deauthentication frames and
6561  * locally generated ones. This function may sleep. The caller must hold the
6562  * corresponding wdev's mutex.
6563  */
6564 void cfg80211_tx_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
6565 			   bool reconnect);
6566 
6567 /**
6568  * cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt - notification of unprotected mlme mgmt frame
6569  * @dev: network device
6570  * @buf: received management frame (header + body)
6571  * @len: length of the frame data
6572  *
6573  * This function is called whenever a received deauthentication or dissassoc
6574  * frame has been dropped in station mode because of MFP being used but the
6575  * frame was not protected. This is also used to notify reception of a Beacon
6576  * frame that was dropped because it did not include a valid MME MIC while
6577  * beacon protection was enabled (BIGTK configured in station mode).
6578  *
6579  * This function may sleep.
6580  */
6581 void cfg80211_rx_unprot_mlme_mgmt(struct net_device *dev,
6582 				  const u8 *buf, size_t len);
6583 
6584 /**
6585  * cfg80211_michael_mic_failure - notification of Michael MIC failure (TKIP)
6586  * @dev: network device
6587  * @addr: The source MAC address of the frame
6588  * @key_type: The key type that the received frame used
6589  * @key_id: Key identifier (0..3). Can be -1 if missing.
6590  * @tsc: The TSC value of the frame that generated the MIC failure (6 octets)
6591  * @gfp: allocation flags
6592  *
6593  * This function is called whenever the local MAC detects a MIC failure in a
6594  * received frame. This matches with MLME-MICHAELMICFAILURE.indication()
6595  * primitive.
6596  */
6597 void cfg80211_michael_mic_failure(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
6598 				  enum nl80211_key_type key_type, int key_id,
6599 				  const u8 *tsc, gfp_t gfp);
6600 
6601 /**
6602  * cfg80211_ibss_joined - notify cfg80211 that device joined an IBSS
6603  *
6604  * @dev: network device
6605  * @bssid: the BSSID of the IBSS joined
6606  * @channel: the channel of the IBSS joined
6607  * @gfp: allocation flags
6608  *
6609  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the device joined an IBSS or
6610  * switched to a different BSSID. Before this function can be called,
6611  * either a beacon has to have been received from the IBSS, or one of
6612  * the cfg80211_inform_bss{,_frame} functions must have been called
6613  * with the locally generated beacon -- this guarantees that there is
6614  * always a scan result for this IBSS. cfg80211 will handle the rest.
6615  */
6616 void cfg80211_ibss_joined(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
6617 			  struct ieee80211_channel *channel, gfp_t gfp);
6618 
6619 /**
6620  * cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate - notify cfg80211 of a new mesh peer
6621  * 					candidate
6622  *
6623  * @dev: network device
6624  * @macaddr: the MAC address of the new candidate
6625  * @ie: information elements advertised by the peer candidate
6626  * @ie_len: length of the information elements buffer
6627  * @gfp: allocation flags
6628  *
6629  * This function notifies cfg80211 that the mesh peer candidate has been
6630  * detected, most likely via a beacon or, less likely, via a probe response.
6631  * cfg80211 then sends a notification to userspace.
6632  */
6633 void cfg80211_notify_new_peer_candidate(struct net_device *dev,
6634 		const u8 *macaddr, const u8 *ie, u8 ie_len,
6635 		int sig_dbm, gfp_t gfp);
6636 
6637 /**
6638  * DOC: RFkill integration
6639  *
6640  * RFkill integration in cfg80211 is almost invisible to drivers,
6641  * as cfg80211 automatically registers an rfkill instance for each
6642  * wireless device it knows about. Soft kill is also translated
6643  * into disconnecting and turning all interfaces off, drivers are
6644  * expected to turn off the device when all interfaces are down.
6645  *
6646  * However, devices may have a hard RFkill line, in which case they
6647  * also need to interact with the rfkill subsystem, via cfg80211.
6648  * They can do this with a few helper functions documented here.
6649  */
6650 
6651 /**
6652  * wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason - notify cfg80211 about hw block state
6653  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6654  * @blocked: block status
6655  * @reason: one of reasons in &enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons
6656  */
6657 void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked,
6658 				      enum rfkill_hard_block_reasons reason);
6659 
6660 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state(struct wiphy *wiphy, bool blocked)
6661 {
6662 	wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state_reason(wiphy, blocked,
6663 					 RFKILL_HARD_BLOCK_SIGNAL);
6664 }
6665 
6666 /**
6667  * wiphy_rfkill_start_polling - start polling rfkill
6668  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6669  */
6670 void wiphy_rfkill_start_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6671 
6672 /**
6673  * wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling - stop polling rfkill
6674  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6675  */
6676 static inline void wiphy_rfkill_stop_polling(struct wiphy *wiphy)
6677 {
6678 	rfkill_pause_polling(wiphy->rfkill);
6679 }
6680 
6681 /**
6682  * DOC: Vendor commands
6683  *
6684  * Occasionally, there are special protocol or firmware features that
6685  * can't be implemented very openly. For this and similar cases, the
6686  * vendor command functionality allows implementing the features with
6687  * (typically closed-source) userspace and firmware, using nl80211 as
6688  * the configuration mechanism.
6689  *
6690  * A driver supporting vendor commands must register them as an array
6691  * in struct wiphy, with handlers for each one, each command has an
6692  * OUI and sub command ID to identify it.
6693  *
6694  * Note that this feature should not be (ab)used to implement protocol
6695  * features that could openly be shared across drivers. In particular,
6696  * it must never be required to use vendor commands to implement any
6697  * "normal" functionality that higher-level userspace like connection
6698  * managers etc. need.
6699  */
6700 
6701 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6702 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6703 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6704 					   int approxlen);
6705 
6706 struct sk_buff *__cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6707 					   struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6708 					   enum nl80211_commands cmd,
6709 					   enum nl80211_attrs attr,
6710 					   unsigned int portid,
6711 					   int vendor_event_idx,
6712 					   int approxlen, gfp_t gfp);
6713 
6714 void __cfg80211_send_event_skb(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp);
6715 
6716 /**
6717  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb - allocate vendor command reply
6718  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6719  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6720  *	be put into the skb
6721  *
6722  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6723  * a vendor command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6724  * it outside of a vendor command's doit() operation is invalid.
6725  *
6726  * The returned skb is pre-filled with some identifying data in
6727  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6728  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6729  * %NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6730  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6731  * which can then read that data out of the vendor data attribute.
6732  * You must not modify the skb in any other way.
6733  *
6734  * When done, call cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply() with the skb and return
6735  * its error code as the result of the doit() operation.
6736  *
6737  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6738  */
6739 static inline struct sk_buff *
6740 cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6741 {
6742 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6743 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA, approxlen);
6744 }
6745 
6746 /**
6747  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply - send the reply skb
6748  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6749  *	cfg80211_vendor_cmd_alloc_reply_skb()
6750  *
6751  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6752  * before returning from the vendor command doit() you should
6753  * return the error code.  Note that this function consumes the
6754  * skb regardless of the return value.
6755  *
6756  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6757  */
6758 int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(struct sk_buff *skb);
6759 
6760 /**
6761  * cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender - get the current sender netlink ID
6762  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6763  *
6764  * Return the current netlink port ID in a vendor command handler.
6765  * Valid to call only there.
6766  */
6767 unsigned int cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(struct wiphy *wiphy);
6768 
6769 /**
6770  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc - allocate vendor-specific event skb
6771  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6772  * @wdev: the wireless device
6773  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6774  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6775  *	be put into the skb
6776  * @gfp: allocation flags
6777  *
6778  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6779  * vendor-specific multicast group.
6780  *
6781  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6782  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6783  * attribute.
6784  *
6785  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6786  * skb to send the event.
6787  *
6788  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6789  */
6790 static inline struct sk_buff *
6791 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6792 			     int approxlen, int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6793 {
6794 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6795 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6796 					  0, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6797 }
6798 
6799 /**
6800  * cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast - alloc unicast vendor-specific event skb
6801  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6802  * @wdev: the wireless device
6803  * @event_idx: index of the vendor event in the wiphy's vendor_events
6804  * @portid: port ID of the receiver
6805  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6806  *	be put into the skb
6807  * @gfp: allocation flags
6808  *
6809  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event to send to
6810  * a specific (userland) socket. This socket would previously have been
6811  * obtained by cfg80211_vendor_cmd_get_sender(), and the caller MUST take
6812  * care to register a netlink notifier to see when the socket closes.
6813  *
6814  * If wdev != NULL, both the ifindex and identifier of the specified
6815  * wireless device are added to the event message before the vendor data
6816  * attribute.
6817  *
6818  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_vendor_event() with the
6819  * skb to send the event.
6820  *
6821  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6822  */
6823 static inline struct sk_buff *
6824 cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc_ucast(struct wiphy *wiphy,
6825 				  struct wireless_dev *wdev,
6826 				  unsigned int portid, int approxlen,
6827 				  int event_idx, gfp_t gfp)
6828 {
6829 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, wdev, NL80211_CMD_VENDOR,
6830 					  NL80211_ATTR_VENDOR_DATA,
6831 					  portid, event_idx, approxlen, gfp);
6832 }
6833 
6834 /**
6835  * cfg80211_vendor_event - send the event
6836  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc()
6837  * @gfp: allocation flags
6838  *
6839  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6840  * by cfg80211_vendor_event_alloc(), as an event. It always consumes it.
6841  */
6842 static inline void cfg80211_vendor_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6843 {
6844 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6845 }
6846 
6847 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
6848 /**
6849  * DOC: Test mode
6850  *
6851  * Test mode is a set of utility functions to allow drivers to
6852  * interact with driver-specific tools to aid, for instance,
6853  * factory programming.
6854  *
6855  * This chapter describes how drivers interact with it, for more
6856  * information see the nl80211 book's chapter on it.
6857  */
6858 
6859 /**
6860  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb - allocate testmode reply
6861  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6862  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6863  *	be put into the skb
6864  *
6865  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for a reply to
6866  * the testmode command. Since it is intended for a reply, calling
6867  * it outside of the @testmode_cmd operation is invalid.
6868  *
6869  * The returned skb is pre-filled with the wiphy index and set up in
6870  * a way that any data that is put into the skb (with skb_put(),
6871  * nla_put() or similar) will end up being within the
6872  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute, so all that needs to be done
6873  * with the skb is adding data for the corresponding userspace tool
6874  * which can then read that data out of the testdata attribute. You
6875  * must not modify the skb in any other way.
6876  *
6877  * When done, call cfg80211_testmode_reply() with the skb and return
6878  * its error code as the result of the @testmode_cmd operation.
6879  *
6880  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6881  */
6882 static inline struct sk_buff *
6883 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen)
6884 {
6885 	return __cfg80211_alloc_reply_skb(wiphy, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6886 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, approxlen);
6887 }
6888 
6889 /**
6890  * cfg80211_testmode_reply - send the reply skb
6891  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6892  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb()
6893  *
6894  * Since calling this function will usually be the last thing
6895  * before returning from the @testmode_cmd you should return
6896  * the error code.  Note that this function consumes the skb
6897  * regardless of the return value.
6898  *
6899  * Return: An error code or 0 on success.
6900  */
6901 static inline int cfg80211_testmode_reply(struct sk_buff *skb)
6902 {
6903 	return cfg80211_vendor_cmd_reply(skb);
6904 }
6905 
6906 /**
6907  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb - allocate testmode event
6908  * @wiphy: the wiphy
6909  * @approxlen: an upper bound of the length of the data that will
6910  *	be put into the skb
6911  * @gfp: allocation flags
6912  *
6913  * This function allocates and pre-fills an skb for an event on the
6914  * testmode multicast group.
6915  *
6916  * The returned skb is set up in the same way as with
6917  * cfg80211_testmode_alloc_reply_skb() but prepared for an event. As
6918  * there, you should simply add data to it that will then end up in the
6919  * %NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA attribute. Again, you must not modify the skb
6920  * in any other way.
6921  *
6922  * When done filling the skb, call cfg80211_testmode_event() with the
6923  * skb to send the event.
6924  *
6925  * Return: An allocated and pre-filled skb. %NULL if any errors happen.
6926  */
6927 static inline struct sk_buff *
6928 cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(struct wiphy *wiphy, int approxlen, gfp_t gfp)
6929 {
6930 	return __cfg80211_alloc_event_skb(wiphy, NULL, NL80211_CMD_TESTMODE,
6931 					  NL80211_ATTR_TESTDATA, 0, -1,
6932 					  approxlen, gfp);
6933 }
6934 
6935 /**
6936  * cfg80211_testmode_event - send the event
6937  * @skb: The skb, must have been allocated with
6938  *	cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb()
6939  * @gfp: allocation flags
6940  *
6941  * This function sends the given @skb, which must have been allocated
6942  * by cfg80211_testmode_alloc_event_skb(), as an event. It always
6943  * consumes it.
6944  */
6945 static inline void cfg80211_testmode_event(struct sk_buff *skb, gfp_t gfp)
6946 {
6947 	__cfg80211_send_event_skb(skb, gfp);
6948 }
6949 
6950 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)	.testmode_cmd = (cmd),
6951 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)	.testmode_dump = (cmd),
6952 #else
6953 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_CMD(cmd)
6954 #define CFG80211_TESTMODE_DUMP(cmd)
6955 #endif
6956 
6957 /**
6958  * struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params - FILS connection response params
6959  * @kek: KEK derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL)
6960  * @kek_len: Length of @fils_kek in octets
6961  * @update_erp_next_seq_num: Boolean value to specify whether the value in
6962  *	@erp_next_seq_num is valid.
6963  * @erp_next_seq_num: The next sequence number to use in ERP message in
6964  *	FILS Authentication. This value should be specified irrespective of the
6965  *	status for a FILS connection.
6966  * @pmk: A new PMK if derived from a successful FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6967  * @pmk_len: Length of @pmk in octets
6968  * @pmkid: A new PMKID if derived from a successful FILS connection or the PMKID
6969  *	used for this FILS connection (may be %NULL).
6970  */
6971 struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params {
6972 	const u8 *kek;
6973 	size_t kek_len;
6974 	bool update_erp_next_seq_num;
6975 	u16 erp_next_seq_num;
6976 	const u8 *pmk;
6977 	size_t pmk_len;
6978 	const u8 *pmkid;
6979 };
6980 
6981 /**
6982  * struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params - Connection response params
6983  * @status: Status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
6984  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
6985  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
6986  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
6987  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
6988  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
6989  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
6990  *	case.
6991  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP (may be %NULL)
6992  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
6993  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
6994  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
6995  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
6996  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
6997  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
6998  * @req_ie: Association request IEs (may be %NULL)
6999  * @req_ie_len: Association request IEs length
7000  * @resp_ie: Association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7001  * @resp_ie_len: Association response IEs length
7002  * @fils: FILS connection response parameters.
7003  * @timeout_reason: Reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7004  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7005  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7006  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7007  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7008  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7009  */
7010 struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params {
7011 	int status;
7012 	const u8 *bssid;
7013 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7014 	const u8 *req_ie;
7015 	size_t req_ie_len;
7016 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7017 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7018 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7019 	enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason;
7020 };
7021 
7022 /**
7023  * cfg80211_connect_done - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7024  *
7025  * @dev: network device
7026  * @params: connection response parameters
7027  * @gfp: allocation flags
7028  *
7029  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7030  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7031  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), but takes a structure pointer for connection response
7032  * parameters. Only one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(),
7033  * cfg80211_connect_result(), cfg80211_connect_timeout(),
7034  * and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7035  */
7036 void cfg80211_connect_done(struct net_device *dev,
7037 			   struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params *params,
7038 			   gfp_t gfp);
7039 
7040 /**
7041  * cfg80211_connect_bss - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7042  *
7043  * @dev: network device
7044  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7045  * @bss: Entry of bss to which STA got connected to, can be obtained through
7046  *	cfg80211_get_bss() (may be %NULL). But it is recommended to store the
7047  *	bss from the connect_request and hold a reference to it and return
7048  *	through this param to avoid a warning if the bss is expired during the
7049  *	connection, esp. for those drivers implementing connect op.
7050  *	Only one parameter among @bssid and @bss needs to be specified.
7051  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7052  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7053  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7054  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7055  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7056  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7057  *	the real status code for failures. If this call is used to report a
7058  *	failure due to a timeout (e.g., not receiving an Authentication frame
7059  *	from the AP) instead of an explicit rejection by the AP, -1 is used to
7060  *	indicate that this is a failure, but without a status code.
7061  *	@timeout_reason is used to report the reason for the timeout in that
7062  *	case.
7063  * @gfp: allocation flags
7064  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout. This is used when the
7065  *	connection fails due to a timeout instead of an explicit rejection from
7066  *	the AP. %NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED is used when the timeout reason is
7067  *	not known. This value is used only if @status < 0 to indicate that the
7068  *	failure is due to a timeout and not due to explicit rejection by the AP.
7069  *	This value is ignored in other cases (@status >= 0).
7070  *
7071  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7072  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7073  * cfg80211_connect_result(), but with the option of identifying the exact bss
7074  * entry for the connection. Only one of the functions among
7075  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7076  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7077  */
7078 static inline void
7079 cfg80211_connect_bss(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7080 		     struct cfg80211_bss *bss, const u8 *req_ie,
7081 		     size_t req_ie_len, const u8 *resp_ie,
7082 		     size_t resp_ie_len, int status, gfp_t gfp,
7083 		     enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7084 {
7085 	struct cfg80211_connect_resp_params params;
7086 
7087 	memset(&params, 0, sizeof(params));
7088 	params.status = status;
7089 	params.bssid = bssid;
7090 	params.bss = bss;
7091 	params.req_ie = req_ie;
7092 	params.req_ie_len = req_ie_len;
7093 	params.resp_ie = resp_ie;
7094 	params.resp_ie_len = resp_ie_len;
7095 	params.timeout_reason = timeout_reason;
7096 
7097 	cfg80211_connect_done(dev, &params, gfp);
7098 }
7099 
7100 /**
7101  * cfg80211_connect_result - notify cfg80211 of connection result
7102  *
7103  * @dev: network device
7104  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7105  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7106  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7107  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7108  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7109  * @status: status code, %WLAN_STATUS_SUCCESS for successful connection, use
7110  *	%WLAN_STATUS_UNSPECIFIED_FAILURE if your device cannot give you
7111  *	the real status code for failures.
7112  * @gfp: allocation flags
7113  *
7114  * It should be called by the underlying driver once execution of the connection
7115  * request from connect() has been completed. This is similar to
7116  * cfg80211_connect_bss() which allows the exact bss entry to be specified. Only
7117  * one of the functions among cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7118  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7119  */
7120 static inline void
7121 cfg80211_connect_result(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7122 			const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len,
7123 			const u8 *resp_ie, size_t resp_ie_len,
7124 			u16 status, gfp_t gfp)
7125 {
7126 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, resp_ie,
7127 			     resp_ie_len, status, gfp,
7128 			     NL80211_TIMEOUT_UNSPECIFIED);
7129 }
7130 
7131 /**
7132  * cfg80211_connect_timeout - notify cfg80211 of connection timeout
7133  *
7134  * @dev: network device
7135  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7136  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7137  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7138  * @gfp: allocation flags
7139  * @timeout_reason: reason for connection timeout.
7140  *
7141  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever connect() has failed
7142  * in a sequence where no explicit authentication/association rejection was
7143  * received from the AP. This could happen, e.g., due to not being able to send
7144  * out the Authentication or Association Request frame or timing out while
7145  * waiting for the response. Only one of the functions among
7146  * cfg80211_connect_bss(), cfg80211_connect_result(),
7147  * cfg80211_connect_timeout(), and cfg80211_connect_done() should be called.
7148  */
7149 static inline void
7150 cfg80211_connect_timeout(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7151 			 const u8 *req_ie, size_t req_ie_len, gfp_t gfp,
7152 			 enum nl80211_timeout_reason timeout_reason)
7153 {
7154 	cfg80211_connect_bss(dev, bssid, NULL, req_ie, req_ie_len, NULL, 0, -1,
7155 			     gfp, timeout_reason);
7156 }
7157 
7158 /**
7159  * struct cfg80211_roam_info - driver initiated roaming information
7160  *
7161  * @channel: the channel of the new AP
7162  * @bss: entry of bss to which STA got roamed (may be %NULL if %bssid is set)
7163  * @bssid: the BSSID of the new AP (may be %NULL if %bss is set)
7164  * @req_ie: association request IEs (maybe be %NULL)
7165  * @req_ie_len: association request IEs length
7166  * @resp_ie: association response IEs (may be %NULL)
7167  * @resp_ie_len: assoc response IEs length
7168  * @fils: FILS related roaming information.
7169  */
7170 struct cfg80211_roam_info {
7171 	struct ieee80211_channel *channel;
7172 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
7173 	const u8 *bssid;
7174 	const u8 *req_ie;
7175 	size_t req_ie_len;
7176 	const u8 *resp_ie;
7177 	size_t resp_ie_len;
7178 	struct cfg80211_fils_resp_params fils;
7179 };
7180 
7181 /**
7182  * cfg80211_roamed - notify cfg80211 of roaming
7183  *
7184  * @dev: network device
7185  * @info: information about the new BSS. struct &cfg80211_roam_info.
7186  * @gfp: allocation flags
7187  *
7188  * This function may be called with the driver passing either the BSSID of the
7189  * new AP or passing the bss entry to avoid a race in timeout of the bss entry.
7190  * It should be called by the underlying driver whenever it roamed from one AP
7191  * to another while connected. Drivers which have roaming implemented in
7192  * firmware should pass the bss entry to avoid a race in bss entry timeout where
7193  * the bss entry of the new AP is seen in the driver, but gets timed out by the
7194  * time it is accessed in __cfg80211_roamed() due to delay in scheduling
7195  * rdev->event_work. In case of any failures, the reference is released
7196  * either in cfg80211_roamed() or in __cfg80211_romed(), Otherwise, it will be
7197  * released while disconnecting from the current bss.
7198  */
7199 void cfg80211_roamed(struct net_device *dev, struct cfg80211_roam_info *info,
7200 		     gfp_t gfp);
7201 
7202 /**
7203  * cfg80211_port_authorized - notify cfg80211 of successful security association
7204  *
7205  * @dev: network device
7206  * @bssid: the BSSID of the AP
7207  * @gfp: allocation flags
7208  *
7209  * This function should be called by a driver that supports 4 way handshake
7210  * offload after a security association was successfully established (i.e.,
7211  * the 4 way handshake was completed successfully). The call to this function
7212  * should be preceded with a call to cfg80211_connect_result(),
7213  * cfg80211_connect_done(), cfg80211_connect_bss() or cfg80211_roamed() to
7214  * indicate the 802.11 association.
7215  */
7216 void cfg80211_port_authorized(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7217 			      gfp_t gfp);
7218 
7219 /**
7220  * cfg80211_disconnected - notify cfg80211 that connection was dropped
7221  *
7222  * @dev: network device
7223  * @ie: information elements of the deauth/disassoc frame (may be %NULL)
7224  * @ie_len: length of IEs
7225  * @reason: reason code for the disconnection, set it to 0 if unknown
7226  * @locally_generated: disconnection was requested locally
7227  * @gfp: allocation flags
7228  *
7229  * After it calls this function, the driver should enter an idle state
7230  * and not try to connect to any AP any more.
7231  */
7232 void cfg80211_disconnected(struct net_device *dev, u16 reason,
7233 			   const u8 *ie, size_t ie_len,
7234 			   bool locally_generated, gfp_t gfp);
7235 
7236 /**
7237  * cfg80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain_on_channel start
7238  * @wdev: wireless device
7239  * @cookie: the request cookie
7240  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7241  * @duration: Duration in milliseconds that the driver intents to remain on the
7242  *	channel
7243  * @gfp: allocation flags
7244  */
7245 void cfg80211_ready_on_channel(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7246 			       struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7247 			       unsigned int duration, gfp_t gfp);
7248 
7249 /**
7250  * cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7251  * @wdev: wireless device
7252  * @cookie: the request cookie
7253  * @chan: The current channel (from remain_on_channel request)
7254  * @gfp: allocation flags
7255  */
7256 void cfg80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7257 					struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
7258 					gfp_t gfp);
7259 
7260 /**
7261  * cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired - tx_mgmt duration expired
7262  * @wdev: wireless device
7263  * @cookie: the requested cookie
7264  * @chan: The current channel (from tx_mgmt request)
7265  * @gfp: allocation flags
7266  */
7267 void cfg80211_tx_mgmt_expired(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7268 			      struct ieee80211_channel *chan, gfp_t gfp);
7269 
7270 /**
7271  * cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats - allocate per-tid statistics.
7272  *
7273  * @sinfo: the station information
7274  * @gfp: allocation flags
7275  */
7276 int cfg80211_sinfo_alloc_tid_stats(struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7277 
7278 /**
7279  * cfg80211_sinfo_release_content - release contents of station info
7280  * @sinfo: the station information
7281  *
7282  * Releases any potentially allocated sub-information of the station
7283  * information, but not the struct itself (since it's typically on
7284  * the stack.)
7285  */
7286 static inline void cfg80211_sinfo_release_content(struct station_info *sinfo)
7287 {
7288 	kfree(sinfo->pertid);
7289 }
7290 
7291 /**
7292  * cfg80211_new_sta - notify userspace about station
7293  *
7294  * @dev: the netdev
7295  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7296  * @sinfo: the station information
7297  * @gfp: allocation flags
7298  */
7299 void cfg80211_new_sta(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7300 		      struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7301 
7302 /**
7303  * cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7304  * @dev: the netdev
7305  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7306  * @sinfo: the station information/statistics
7307  * @gfp: allocation flags
7308  */
7309 void cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7310 			    struct station_info *sinfo, gfp_t gfp);
7311 
7312 /**
7313  * cfg80211_del_sta - notify userspace about deletion of a station
7314  *
7315  * @dev: the netdev
7316  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7317  * @gfp: allocation flags
7318  */
7319 static inline void cfg80211_del_sta(struct net_device *dev,
7320 				    const u8 *mac_addr, gfp_t gfp)
7321 {
7322 	cfg80211_del_sta_sinfo(dev, mac_addr, NULL, gfp);
7323 }
7324 
7325 /**
7326  * cfg80211_conn_failed - connection request failed notification
7327  *
7328  * @dev: the netdev
7329  * @mac_addr: the station's address
7330  * @reason: the reason for connection failure
7331  * @gfp: allocation flags
7332  *
7333  * Whenever a station tries to connect to an AP and if the station
7334  * could not connect to the AP as the AP has rejected the connection
7335  * for some reasons, this function is called.
7336  *
7337  * The reason for connection failure can be any of the value from
7338  * nl80211_connect_failed_reason enum
7339  */
7340 void cfg80211_conn_failed(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac_addr,
7341 			  enum nl80211_connect_failed_reason reason,
7342 			  gfp_t gfp);
7343 
7344 /**
7345  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7346  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7347  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in KHz
7348  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7349  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7350  * @len: length of the frame data
7351  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7352  *
7353  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7354  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7355  *
7356  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7357  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7358  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7359  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7360  */
7361 bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq, int sig_dbm,
7362 			  const u8 *buf, size_t len, u32 flags);
7363 
7364 /**
7365  * cfg80211_rx_mgmt - notification of received, unprocessed management frame
7366  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7367  * @freq: Frequency on which the frame was received in MHz
7368  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7369  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7370  * @len: length of the frame data
7371  * @flags: flags, as defined in enum nl80211_rxmgmt_flags
7372  *
7373  * This function is called whenever an Action frame is received for a station
7374  * mode interface, but is not processed in kernel.
7375  *
7376  * Return: %true if a user space application has registered for this frame.
7377  * For action frames, that makes it responsible for rejecting unrecognized
7378  * action frames; %false otherwise, in which case for action frames the
7379  * driver is responsible for rejecting the frame.
7380  */
7381 static inline bool cfg80211_rx_mgmt(struct wireless_dev *wdev, int freq,
7382 				    int sig_dbm, const u8 *buf, size_t len,
7383 				    u32 flags)
7384 {
7385 	return cfg80211_rx_mgmt_khz(wdev, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq), sig_dbm, buf, len,
7386 				    flags);
7387 }
7388 
7389 /**
7390  * cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status - notification of TX status for management frame
7391  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7392  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx()
7393  * @buf: Management frame (header + body)
7394  * @len: length of the frame data
7395  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7396  * @gfp: context flags
7397  *
7398  * This function is called whenever a management frame was requested to be
7399  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::mgmt_tx() to report the TX status of the
7400  * transmission attempt.
7401  */
7402 void cfg80211_mgmt_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7403 			     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack, gfp_t gfp);
7404 
7405 /**
7406  * cfg80211_control_port_tx_status - notification of TX status for control
7407  *                                   port frames
7408  * @wdev: wireless device receiving the frame
7409  * @cookie: Cookie returned by cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port()
7410  * @buf: Data frame (header + body)
7411  * @len: length of the frame data
7412  * @ack: Whether frame was acknowledged
7413  * @gfp: context flags
7414  *
7415  * This function is called whenever a control port frame was requested to be
7416  * transmitted with cfg80211_ops::tx_control_port() to report the TX status of
7417  * the transmission attempt.
7418  */
7419 void cfg80211_control_port_tx_status(struct wireless_dev *wdev, u64 cookie,
7420 				     const u8 *buf, size_t len, bool ack,
7421 				     gfp_t gfp);
7422 
7423 /**
7424  * cfg80211_rx_control_port - notification about a received control port frame
7425  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7426  * @skb: The skbuf with the control port frame.  It is assumed that the skbuf
7427  *	is 802.3 formatted (with 802.3 header).  The skb can be non-linear.
7428  *	This function does not take ownership of the skb, so the caller is
7429  *	responsible for any cleanup.  The caller must also ensure that
7430  *	skb->protocol is set appropriately.
7431  * @unencrypted: Whether the frame was received unencrypted
7432  *
7433  * This function is used to inform userspace about a received control port
7434  * frame.  It should only be used if userspace indicated it wants to receive
7435  * control port frames over nl80211.
7436  *
7437  * The frame is the data portion of the 802.3 or 802.11 data frame with all
7438  * network layer headers removed (e.g. the raw EAPoL frame).
7439  *
7440  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace
7441  */
7442 bool cfg80211_rx_control_port(struct net_device *dev,
7443 			      struct sk_buff *skb, bool unencrypted);
7444 
7445 /**
7446  * cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify - connection quality monitoring rssi event
7447  * @dev: network device
7448  * @rssi_event: the triggered RSSI event
7449  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
7450  * @gfp: context flags
7451  *
7452  * This function is called when a configured connection quality monitoring
7453  * rssi threshold reached event occurs.
7454  */
7455 void cfg80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7456 			      enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
7457 			      s32 rssi_level, gfp_t gfp);
7458 
7459 /**
7460  * cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify - notify userspace about packetloss to peer
7461  * @dev: network device
7462  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7463  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost -- should be a fixed threshold
7464  *	but probably no less than maybe 50, or maybe a throughput dependent
7465  *	threshold (to account for temporary interference)
7466  * @gfp: context flags
7467  */
7468 void cfg80211_cqm_pktloss_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7469 				 const u8 *peer, u32 num_packets, gfp_t gfp);
7470 
7471 /**
7472  * cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify - TX error rate event
7473  * @dev: network device
7474  * @peer: peer's MAC address
7475  * @num_packets: how many packets were lost
7476  * @rate: % of packets which failed transmission
7477  * @intvl: interval (in s) over which the TX failure threshold was breached.
7478  * @gfp: context flags
7479  *
7480  * Notify userspace when configured % TX failures over number of packets in a
7481  * given interval is exceeded.
7482  */
7483 void cfg80211_cqm_txe_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7484 			     u32 num_packets, u32 rate, u32 intvl, gfp_t gfp);
7485 
7486 /**
7487  * cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - beacon loss event
7488  * @dev: network device
7489  * @gfp: context flags
7490  *
7491  * Notify userspace about beacon loss from the connected AP.
7492  */
7493 void cfg80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct net_device *dev, gfp_t gfp);
7494 
7495 /**
7496  * cfg80211_radar_event - radar detection event
7497  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7498  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7499  * @gfp: context flags
7500  *
7501  * This function is called when a radar is detected on the current chanenl.
7502  */
7503 void cfg80211_radar_event(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7504 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef, gfp_t gfp);
7505 
7506 /**
7507  * cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify - STA's ht/vht operation mode change event
7508  * @dev: network device
7509  * @mac: MAC address of a station which opmode got modified
7510  * @sta_opmode: station's current opmode value
7511  * @gfp: context flags
7512  *
7513  * Driver should call this function when station's opmode modified via action
7514  * frame.
7515  */
7516 void cfg80211_sta_opmode_change_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *mac,
7517 				       struct sta_opmode_info *sta_opmode,
7518 				       gfp_t gfp);
7519 
7520 /**
7521  * cfg80211_cac_event - Channel availability check (CAC) event
7522  * @netdev: network device
7523  * @chandef: chandef for the current channel
7524  * @event: type of event
7525  * @gfp: context flags
7526  *
7527  * This function is called when a Channel availability check (CAC) is finished
7528  * or aborted. This must be called to notify the completion of a CAC process,
7529  * also by full-MAC drivers.
7530  */
7531 void cfg80211_cac_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7532 			const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7533 			enum nl80211_radar_event event, gfp_t gfp);
7534 
7535 
7536 /**
7537  * cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace about driver rekeying
7538  * @dev: network device
7539  * @bssid: BSSID of AP (to avoid races)
7540  * @replay_ctr: new replay counter
7541  * @gfp: allocation flags
7542  */
7543 void cfg80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *bssid,
7544 			       const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
7545 
7546 /**
7547  * cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify - notify about PMKSA caching candidate
7548  * @dev: network device
7549  * @index: candidate index (the smaller the index, the higher the priority)
7550  * @bssid: BSSID of AP
7551  * @preauth: Whether AP advertises support for RSN pre-authentication
7552  * @gfp: allocation flags
7553  */
7554 void cfg80211_pmksa_candidate_notify(struct net_device *dev, int index,
7555 				     const u8 *bssid, bool preauth, gfp_t gfp);
7556 
7557 /**
7558  * cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame - inform userspace about a spurious frame
7559  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7560  * @addr: the transmitter address
7561  * @gfp: context flags
7562  *
7563  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7564  * a spurious class 3 frame was received, to be able to deauth the
7565  * sender.
7566  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7567  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7568  */
7569 bool cfg80211_rx_spurious_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7570 				const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7571 
7572 /**
7573  * cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame - inform about unexpected WDS frame
7574  * @dev: The device the frame matched to
7575  * @addr: the transmitter address
7576  * @gfp: context flags
7577  *
7578  * This function is used in AP mode (only!) to inform userspace that
7579  * an associated station sent a 4addr frame but that wasn't expected.
7580  * It is allowed and desirable to send this event only once for each
7581  * station to avoid event flooding.
7582  * Return: %true if the frame was passed to userspace (or this failed
7583  * for a reason other than not having a subscription.)
7584  */
7585 bool cfg80211_rx_unexpected_4addr_frame(struct net_device *dev,
7586 					const u8 *addr, gfp_t gfp);
7587 
7588 /**
7589  * cfg80211_probe_status - notify userspace about probe status
7590  * @dev: the device the probe was sent on
7591  * @addr: the address of the peer
7592  * @cookie: the cookie filled in @probe_client previously
7593  * @acked: indicates whether probe was acked or not
7594  * @ack_signal: signal strength (in dBm) of the ACK frame.
7595  * @is_valid_ack_signal: indicates the ack_signal is valid or not.
7596  * @gfp: allocation flags
7597  */
7598 void cfg80211_probe_status(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *addr,
7599 			   u64 cookie, bool acked, s32 ack_signal,
7600 			   bool is_valid_ack_signal, gfp_t gfp);
7601 
7602 /**
7603  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz - report beacon from other APs
7604  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7605  * @frame: the frame
7606  * @len: length of the frame
7607  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on in KHz
7608  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7609  *
7610  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7611  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7612  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7613  */
7614 void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(struct wiphy *wiphy, const u8 *frame,
7615 				     size_t len, int freq, int sig_dbm);
7616 
7617 /**
7618  * cfg80211_report_obss_beacon - report beacon from other APs
7619  * @wiphy: The wiphy that received the beacon
7620  * @frame: the frame
7621  * @len: length of the frame
7622  * @freq: frequency the frame was received on
7623  * @sig_dbm: signal strength in dBm, or 0 if unknown
7624  *
7625  * Use this function to report to userspace when a beacon was
7626  * received. It is not useful to call this when there is no
7627  * netdev that is in AP/GO mode.
7628  */
7629 static inline void cfg80211_report_obss_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7630 					       const u8 *frame, size_t len,
7631 					       int freq, int sig_dbm)
7632 {
7633 	cfg80211_report_obss_beacon_khz(wiphy, frame, len, MHZ_TO_KHZ(freq),
7634 					sig_dbm);
7635 }
7636 
7637 /**
7638  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon - check if beaconing is allowed
7639  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7640  * @chandef: the channel definition
7641  * @iftype: interface type
7642  *
7643  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7644  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.)
7645  */
7646 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7647 			     struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7648 			     enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7649 
7650 /**
7651  * cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax - check if beaconing is allowed with relaxation
7652  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7653  * @chandef: the channel definition
7654  * @iftype: interface type
7655  *
7656  * Return: %true if there is no secondary channel or the secondary channel(s)
7657  * can be used for beaconing (i.e. is not a radar channel etc.). This version
7658  * also checks if IR-relaxation conditions apply, to allow beaconing under
7659  * more permissive conditions.
7660  *
7661  * Requires the wiphy mutex to be held.
7662  */
7663 bool cfg80211_reg_can_beacon_relax(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7664 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7665 				   enum nl80211_iftype iftype);
7666 
7667 /*
7668  * cfg80211_ch_switch_notify - update wdev channel and notify userspace
7669  * @dev: the device which switched channels
7670  * @chandef: the new channel definition
7671  *
7672  * Caller must acquire wdev_lock, therefore must only be called from sleepable
7673  * driver context!
7674  */
7675 void cfg80211_ch_switch_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7676 			       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
7677 
7678 /*
7679  * cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify - notify channel switch start
7680  * @dev: the device on which the channel switch started
7681  * @chandef: the future channel definition
7682  * @count: the number of TBTTs until the channel switch happens
7683  * @quiet: whether or not immediate quiet was requested by the AP
7684  *
7685  * Inform the userspace about the channel switch that has just
7686  * started, so that it can take appropriate actions (eg. starting
7687  * channel switch on other vifs), if necessary.
7688  */
7689 void cfg80211_ch_switch_started_notify(struct net_device *dev,
7690 				       struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7691 				       u8 count, bool quiet);
7692 
7693 /**
7694  * ieee80211_operating_class_to_band - convert operating class to band
7695  *
7696  * @operating_class: the operating class to convert
7697  * @band: band pointer to fill
7698  *
7699  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7700  */
7701 bool ieee80211_operating_class_to_band(u8 operating_class,
7702 				       enum nl80211_band *band);
7703 
7704 /**
7705  * ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class - convert chandef to operation class
7706  *
7707  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7708  * @op_class: a pointer to the resulting operating class
7709  *
7710  * Returns %true if the conversion was successful, %false otherwise.
7711  */
7712 bool ieee80211_chandef_to_operating_class(struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7713 					  u8 *op_class);
7714 
7715 /**
7716  * ieee80211_chandef_to_khz - convert chandef to frequency in KHz
7717  *
7718  * @chandef: the chandef to convert
7719  *
7720  * Returns the center frequency of chandef (1st segment) in KHz.
7721  */
7722 static inline u32
7723 ieee80211_chandef_to_khz(const struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef)
7724 {
7725 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(chandef->center_freq1) + chandef->freq1_offset;
7726 }
7727 
7728 /*
7729  * cfg80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform TDLS operation
7730  * @dev: the device on which the operation is requested
7731  * @peer: the MAC address of the peer device
7732  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation (NL80211_TDLS_SETUP or
7733  *	NL80211_TDLS_TEARDOWN)
7734  * @reason_code: the reason code for teardown request
7735  * @gfp: allocation flags
7736  *
7737  * This function is used to request userspace to perform TDLS operation that
7738  * requires knowledge of keys, i.e., link setup or teardown when the AP
7739  * connection uses encryption. This is optional mechanism for the driver to use
7740  * if it can automatically determine when a TDLS link could be useful (e.g.,
7741  * based on traffic and signal strength for a peer).
7742  */
7743 void cfg80211_tdls_oper_request(struct net_device *dev, const u8 *peer,
7744 				enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7745 				u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7746 
7747 /*
7748  * cfg80211_calculate_bitrate - calculate actual bitrate (in 100Kbps units)
7749  * @rate: given rate_info to calculate bitrate from
7750  *
7751  * return 0 if MCS index >= 32
7752  */
7753 u32 cfg80211_calculate_bitrate(struct rate_info *rate);
7754 
7755 /**
7756  * cfg80211_unregister_wdev - remove the given wdev
7757  * @wdev: struct wireless_dev to remove
7758  *
7759  * This function removes the device so it can no longer be used. It is necessary
7760  * to call this function even when cfg80211 requests the removal of the device
7761  * by calling the del_virtual_intf() callback. The function must also be called
7762  * when the driver wishes to unregister the wdev, e.g. when the hardware device
7763  * is unbound from the driver.
7764  *
7765  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7766  */
7767 void cfg80211_unregister_wdev(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
7768 
7769 /**
7770  * cfg80211_register_netdevice - register the given netdev
7771  * @dev: the netdev to register
7772  *
7773  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
7774  * than register_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL is
7775  * held. Otherwise, both register_netdevice() and register_netdev() are usable
7776  * instead as well.
7777  *
7778  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7779  */
7780 int cfg80211_register_netdevice(struct net_device *dev);
7781 
7782 /**
7783  * cfg80211_unregister_netdevice - unregister the given netdev
7784  * @dev: the netdev to register
7785  *
7786  * Note: In contexts coming from cfg80211 callbacks, you must call this rather
7787  * than unregister_netdevice(), unregister_netdev() is impossible as the RTNL
7788  * is held. Otherwise, both unregister_netdevice() and unregister_netdev() are
7789  * usable instead as well.
7790  *
7791  * Requires the RTNL and wiphy mutex to be held.
7792  */
7793 static inline void cfg80211_unregister_netdevice(struct net_device *dev)
7794 {
7795 	cfg80211_unregister_wdev(dev->ieee80211_ptr);
7796 }
7797 
7798 /**
7799  * struct cfg80211_ft_event_params - FT Information Elements
7800  * @ies: FT IEs
7801  * @ies_len: length of the FT IE in bytes
7802  * @target_ap: target AP's MAC address
7803  * @ric_ies: RIC IE
7804  * @ric_ies_len: length of the RIC IE in bytes
7805  */
7806 struct cfg80211_ft_event_params {
7807 	const u8 *ies;
7808 	size_t ies_len;
7809 	const u8 *target_ap;
7810 	const u8 *ric_ies;
7811 	size_t ric_ies_len;
7812 };
7813 
7814 /**
7815  * cfg80211_ft_event - notify userspace about FT IE and RIC IE
7816  * @netdev: network device
7817  * @ft_event: IE information
7818  */
7819 void cfg80211_ft_event(struct net_device *netdev,
7820 		       struct cfg80211_ft_event_params *ft_event);
7821 
7822 /**
7823  * cfg80211_get_p2p_attr - find and copy a P2P attribute from IE buffer
7824  * @ies: the input IE buffer
7825  * @len: the input length
7826  * @attr: the attribute ID to find
7827  * @buf: output buffer, can be %NULL if the data isn't needed, e.g.
7828  *	if the function is only called to get the needed buffer size
7829  * @bufsize: size of the output buffer
7830  *
7831  * The function finds a given P2P attribute in the (vendor) IEs and
7832  * copies its contents to the given buffer.
7833  *
7834  * Return: A negative error code (-%EILSEQ or -%ENOENT) if the data is
7835  * malformed or the attribute can't be found (respectively), or the
7836  * length of the found attribute (which can be zero).
7837  */
7838 int cfg80211_get_p2p_attr(const u8 *ies, unsigned int len,
7839 			  enum ieee80211_p2p_attr_id attr,
7840 			  u8 *buf, unsigned int bufsize);
7841 
7842 /**
7843  * ieee80211_ie_split_ric - split an IE buffer according to ordering (with RIC)
7844  * @ies: the IE buffer
7845  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7846  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7847  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7848  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7849  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7850  * @after_ric: array IE types that come after the RIC element
7851  * @n_after_ric: size of the @after_ric array
7852  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7853  *
7854  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7855  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7856  * split.
7857  *
7858  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7859  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7860  *
7861  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7862  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7863  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7864  *
7865  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7866  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7867  * of the buffer should be used.
7868  */
7869 size_t ieee80211_ie_split_ric(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7870 			      const u8 *ids, int n_ids,
7871 			      const u8 *after_ric, int n_after_ric,
7872 			      size_t offset);
7873 
7874 /**
7875  * ieee80211_ie_split - split an IE buffer according to ordering
7876  * @ies: the IE buffer
7877  * @ielen: the length of the IE buffer
7878  * @ids: an array with element IDs that are allowed before
7879  *	the split. A WLAN_EID_EXTENSION value means that the next
7880  *	EID in the list is a sub-element of the EXTENSION IE.
7881  * @n_ids: the size of the element ID array
7882  * @offset: offset where to start splitting in the buffer
7883  *
7884  * This function splits an IE buffer by updating the @offset
7885  * variable to point to the location where the buffer should be
7886  * split.
7887  *
7888  * It assumes that the given IE buffer is well-formed, this
7889  * has to be guaranteed by the caller!
7890  *
7891  * It also assumes that the IEs in the buffer are ordered
7892  * correctly, if not the result of using this function will not
7893  * be ordered correctly either, i.e. it does no reordering.
7894  *
7895  * The function returns the offset where the next part of the
7896  * buffer starts, which may be @ielen if the entire (remainder)
7897  * of the buffer should be used.
7898  */
7899 static inline size_t ieee80211_ie_split(const u8 *ies, size_t ielen,
7900 					const u8 *ids, int n_ids, size_t offset)
7901 {
7902 	return ieee80211_ie_split_ric(ies, ielen, ids, n_ids, NULL, 0, offset);
7903 }
7904 
7905 /**
7906  * cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report wakeup from WoWLAN
7907  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the wakeup
7908  * @wakeup: the wakeup report
7909  * @gfp: allocation flags
7910  *
7911  * This function reports that the given device woke up. If it
7912  * caused the wakeup, report the reason(s), otherwise you may
7913  * pass %NULL as the @wakeup parameter to advertise that something
7914  * else caused the wakeup.
7915  */
7916 void cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7917 				   struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7918 				   gfp_t gfp);
7919 
7920 /**
7921  * cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped() - indicate critical protocol stopped by driver.
7922  *
7923  * @wdev: the wireless device for which critical protocol is stopped.
7924  * @gfp: allocation flags
7925  *
7926  * This function can be called by the driver to indicate it has reverted
7927  * operation back to normal. One reason could be that the duration given
7928  * by .crit_proto_start() has expired.
7929  */
7930 void cfg80211_crit_proto_stopped(struct wireless_dev *wdev, gfp_t gfp);
7931 
7932 /**
7933  * ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels - get number of channels device has
7934  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7935  *
7936  * Return: the number of channels supported by the device.
7937  */
7938 unsigned int ieee80211_get_num_supported_channels(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7939 
7940 /**
7941  * cfg80211_check_combinations - check interface combinations
7942  *
7943  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7944  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7945  *
7946  * This function can be called by the driver to check whether a
7947  * combination of interfaces and their types are allowed according to
7948  * the interface combinations.
7949  */
7950 int cfg80211_check_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7951 				struct iface_combination_params *params);
7952 
7953 /**
7954  * cfg80211_iter_combinations - iterate over matching combinations
7955  *
7956  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7957  * @params: the interface combinations parameter
7958  * @iter: function to call for each matching combination
7959  * @data: pointer to pass to iter function
7960  *
7961  * This function can be called by the driver to check what possible
7962  * combinations it fits in at a given moment, e.g. for channel switching
7963  * purposes.
7964  */
7965 int cfg80211_iter_combinations(struct wiphy *wiphy,
7966 			       struct iface_combination_params *params,
7967 			       void (*iter)(const struct ieee80211_iface_combination *c,
7968 					    void *data),
7969 			       void *data);
7970 
7971 /*
7972  * cfg80211_stop_iface - trigger interface disconnection
7973  *
7974  * @wiphy: the wiphy
7975  * @wdev: wireless device
7976  * @gfp: context flags
7977  *
7978  * Trigger interface to be stopped as if AP was stopped, IBSS/mesh left, STA
7979  * disconnected.
7980  *
7981  * Note: This doesn't need any locks and is asynchronous.
7982  */
7983 void cfg80211_stop_iface(struct wiphy *wiphy, struct wireless_dev *wdev,
7984 			 gfp_t gfp);
7985 
7986 /**
7987  * cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces - shut down all interfaces for a wiphy
7988  * @wiphy: the wiphy to shut down
7989  *
7990  * This function shuts down all interfaces belonging to this wiphy by
7991  * calling dev_close() (and treating non-netdev interfaces as needed).
7992  * It shouldn't really be used unless there are some fatal device errors
7993  * that really can't be recovered in any other way.
7994  *
7995  * Callers must hold the RTNL and be able to deal with callbacks into
7996  * the driver while the function is running.
7997  */
7998 void cfg80211_shutdown_all_interfaces(struct wiphy *wiphy);
7999 
8000 /**
8001  * wiphy_ext_feature_set - set the extended feature flag
8002  *
8003  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8004  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8005  *
8006  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8007  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8008  */
8009 static inline void wiphy_ext_feature_set(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8010 					 enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8011 {
8012 	u8 *ft_byte;
8013 
8014 	ft_byte = &wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8015 	*ft_byte |= BIT(ftidx % 8);
8016 }
8017 
8018 /**
8019  * wiphy_ext_feature_isset - check the extended feature flag
8020  *
8021  * @wiphy: the wiphy to modify.
8022  * @ftidx: extended feature bit index.
8023  *
8024  * The extended features are flagged in multiple bytes (see
8025  * &struct wiphy.@ext_features)
8026  */
8027 static inline bool
8028 wiphy_ext_feature_isset(struct wiphy *wiphy,
8029 			enum nl80211_ext_feature_index ftidx)
8030 {
8031 	u8 ft_byte;
8032 
8033 	ft_byte = wiphy->ext_features[ftidx / 8];
8034 	return (ft_byte & BIT(ftidx % 8)) != 0;
8035 }
8036 
8037 /**
8038  * cfg80211_free_nan_func - free NAN function
8039  * @f: NAN function that should be freed
8040  *
8041  * Frees all the NAN function and all it's allocated members.
8042  */
8043 void cfg80211_free_nan_func(struct cfg80211_nan_func *f);
8044 
8045 /**
8046  * struct cfg80211_nan_match_params - NAN match parameters
8047  * @type: the type of the function that triggered a match. If it is
8048  *	 %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_SUBSCRIBE it means that we replied to a subscriber.
8049  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_PUBLISH, it means that we got a discovery
8050  *	 result.
8051  *	 If it is %NL80211_NAN_FUNC_FOLLOW_UP, we received a follow up.
8052  * @inst_id: the local instance id
8053  * @peer_inst_id: the instance id of the peer's function
8054  * @addr: the MAC address of the peer
8055  * @info_len: the length of the &info
8056  * @info: the Service Specific Info from the peer (if any)
8057  * @cookie: unique identifier of the corresponding function
8058  */
8059 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params {
8060 	enum nl80211_nan_function_type type;
8061 	u8 inst_id;
8062 	u8 peer_inst_id;
8063 	const u8 *addr;
8064 	u8 info_len;
8065 	const u8 *info;
8066 	u64 cookie;
8067 };
8068 
8069 /**
8070  * cfg80211_nan_match - report a match for a NAN function.
8071  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8072  * @match: match notification parameters
8073  * @gfp: allocation flags
8074  *
8075  * This function reports that the a NAN function had a match. This
8076  * can be a subscribe that had a match or a solicited publish that
8077  * was sent. It can also be a follow up that was received.
8078  */
8079 void cfg80211_nan_match(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8080 			struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match, gfp_t gfp);
8081 
8082 /**
8083  * cfg80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
8084  *
8085  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the match
8086  * @inst_id: the local instance id
8087  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
8088  * @cookie: unique NAN function identifier
8089  * @gfp: allocation flags
8090  *
8091  * This function reports that the a NAN function is terminated.
8092  */
8093 void cfg80211_nan_func_terminated(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8094 				  u8 inst_id,
8095 				  enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
8096 				  u64 cookie, gfp_t gfp);
8097 
8098 /* ethtool helper */
8099 void cfg80211_get_drvinfo(struct net_device *dev, struct ethtool_drvinfo *info);
8100 
8101 /**
8102  * cfg80211_external_auth_request - userspace request for authentication
8103  * @netdev: network device
8104  * @params: External authentication parameters
8105  * @gfp: allocation flags
8106  * Returns: 0 on success, < 0 on error
8107  */
8108 int cfg80211_external_auth_request(struct net_device *netdev,
8109 				   struct cfg80211_external_auth_params *params,
8110 				   gfp_t gfp);
8111 
8112 /**
8113  * cfg80211_pmsr_report - report peer measurement result data
8114  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8115  * @req: the original measurement request
8116  * @result: the result data
8117  * @gfp: allocation flags
8118  */
8119 void cfg80211_pmsr_report(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8120 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8121 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_result *result,
8122 			  gfp_t gfp);
8123 
8124 /**
8125  * cfg80211_pmsr_complete - report peer measurement completed
8126  * @wdev: the wireless device reporting the measurement
8127  * @req: the original measurement request
8128  * @gfp: allocation flags
8129  *
8130  * Report that the entire measurement completed, after this
8131  * the request pointer will no longer be valid.
8132  */
8133 void cfg80211_pmsr_complete(struct wireless_dev *wdev,
8134 			    struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *req,
8135 			    gfp_t gfp);
8136 
8137 /**
8138  * cfg80211_iftype_allowed - check whether the interface can be allowed
8139  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8140  * @iftype: interface type
8141  * @is_4addr: use_4addr flag, must be '0' when check_swif is '1'
8142  * @check_swif: check iftype against software interfaces
8143  *
8144  * Check whether the interface is allowed to operate; additionally, this API
8145  * can be used to check iftype against the software interfaces when
8146  * check_swif is '1'.
8147  */
8148 bool cfg80211_iftype_allowed(struct wiphy *wiphy, enum nl80211_iftype iftype,
8149 			     bool is_4addr, u8 check_swif);
8150 
8151 
8152 /* Logging, debugging and troubleshooting/diagnostic helpers. */
8153 
8154 /* wiphy_printk helpers, similar to dev_printk */
8155 
8156 #define wiphy_printk(level, wiphy, format, args...)		\
8157 	dev_printk(level, &(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8158 #define wiphy_emerg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8159 	dev_emerg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8160 #define wiphy_alert(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8161 	dev_alert(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8162 #define wiphy_crit(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8163 	dev_crit(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8164 #define wiphy_err(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8165 	dev_err(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8166 #define wiphy_warn(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8167 	dev_warn(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8168 #define wiphy_notice(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8169 	dev_notice(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8170 #define wiphy_info(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8171 	dev_info(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8172 #define wiphy_info_once(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8173 	dev_info_once(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8174 
8175 #define wiphy_err_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
8176 	dev_err_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8177 #define wiphy_warn_ratelimited(wiphy, format, args...)		\
8178 	dev_warn_ratelimited(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8179 
8180 #define wiphy_debug(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8181 	wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args)
8182 
8183 #define wiphy_dbg(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8184 	dev_dbg(&(wiphy)->dev, format, ##args)
8185 
8186 #if defined(VERBOSE_DEBUG)
8187 #define wiphy_vdbg	wiphy_dbg
8188 #else
8189 #define wiphy_vdbg(wiphy, format, args...)				\
8190 ({									\
8191 	if (0)								\
8192 		wiphy_printk(KERN_DEBUG, wiphy, format, ##args);	\
8193 	0;								\
8194 })
8195 #endif
8196 
8197 /*
8198  * wiphy_WARN() acts like wiphy_printk(), but with the key difference
8199  * of using a WARN/WARN_ON to get the message out, including the
8200  * file/line information and a backtrace.
8201  */
8202 #define wiphy_WARN(wiphy, format, args...)			\
8203 	WARN(1, "wiphy: %s\n" format, wiphy_name(wiphy), ##args);
8204 
8205 /**
8206  * cfg80211_update_owe_info_event - Notify the peer's OWE info to user space
8207  * @netdev: network device
8208  * @owe_info: peer's owe info
8209  * @gfp: allocation flags
8210  */
8211 void cfg80211_update_owe_info_event(struct net_device *netdev,
8212 				    struct cfg80211_update_owe_info *owe_info,
8213 				    gfp_t gfp);
8214 
8215 /**
8216  * cfg80211_bss_flush - resets all the scan entries
8217  * @wiphy: the wiphy
8218  */
8219 void cfg80211_bss_flush(struct wiphy *wiphy);
8220 
8221 #endif /* __NET_CFG80211_H */
8222